0
登录后你可以
  • 下载海量资料
  • 学习在线课程
  • 观看技术视频
  • 写文章/发帖/加入社区
会员中心
创作中心
发布
  • 发文章

  • 发资料

  • 发帖

  • 提问

  • 发视频

创作活动
MT47H256M4B7-37E:ATR

MT47H256M4B7-37E:ATR

  • 厂商:

    MICRON(镁光)

  • 封装:

    FBGA92_11X19MM

  • 描述:

    ICSDRAM1GBIT266MHZ92FBGA

  • 数据手册
  • 价格&库存
MT47H256M4B7-37E:ATR 数据手册
1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Features DDR2 SDRAM MT47H256M4 – 32 Meg x 4 x 8 banks MT47H128M8 – 16 Meg x 8 x 8 banks MT47H64M16 – 8 Meg x 16 x 8 banks For the latest data sheet, refer to Micron’s Web site: http://www.micron.com/ddr2 Features • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • Options RoHS compliant VDD = +1.8V ±0.1V, VDDQ = +1.8V ±0.1V JEDEC standard 1.8V I/O (SSTL_18-compatible) Differential data strobe (DQS, DQS#) option 4-bit prefetch architecture Duplicate output strobe (RDQS) option for x8 DLL to align DQ and DQS transitions with CK 8 internal banks for concurrent operation Programmable CAS latency (CL) Posted CAS additive latency (AL) WRITE latency = READ latency – 1 tCK Programmable burst lengths: 4 or 8 Adjustable data-output drive strength 64ms, 8,192-cycle refresh On-die termination (ODT) Industrial temperature (IT) option Supports JEDEC clock jitter specification Table 1: Table 2: Configuration Addressing Architecture 256 Meg x 4 128 Meg x 8 64 Meg x 16 32 Meg x 4 16 Meg x 4 x 8 banks x 8 banks 8K 8K Refresh Count 16K (A0–A13) 16K (A0–A13) Row Addr. 8 (BA0–BA2) 8 (BA0–BA2) Bank Addr. Column Addr. 2K (A0–A9, A11) 1K (A0–A9) Configuration Marking • Configuration 256 Meg x 4 (32 Meg x 4 x 8 banks ) 128 Meg x 8 (16 Meg x 8 x 8 banks) 64 Meg x 16 (8 Meg x 16 x 8 banks) • FBGA package (lead-free) 92-ball FBGA (11mm x 19mm) (:A) 84-ball FBGA (10mm x 16.5mm) (:D) 68-ball FBGA (10mm x 16.5mm) (:D) • Timing – cycle time 5.0ns @ CL = 3 (DDR2-400) 3.75ns @ CL = 4 (DDR2-533) 3.0ns @ CL = 5 (DDR2-667) 3.0ns @ CL = 4 (DDR2-667) 2.5ns @ CL = 6 (DDR2-800) 2.5ns @ CL = 5 (DDR2-800) • Self refresh Standard Low-power • Operating temperature Commercial (0°C ≤ TC ≤ 85°C) Industrial (–40°C ≤ TC ≤ 95°C; –40°C ≤ TA ≤ 85°C) • Revision 256M4 128M8 64M16 BT B7 B7 -5E -37E -3 -3E -25 -25E None L None IT :A/:D Key Timing Parameters Data Rate (MHz) t Speed RCD tRP Grade CL = 3 CL = 4 CL = 5 CL = 6 (ns) (ns) 8 Meg x 16 x 8 banks 8K 8K (A0–A12) 8 (BA0–BA2) 1K (A0–A9) -5E -37E -3 -3E -25 -25E 400 400 400 N/A N/A N/A 400 533 533 667 N/A 533 N/A N/A 667 667 667 800 N/A N/A N/A N/A 800 N/A 15 15 15 12 15 12.5 15 15 15 12 15 12.5 t RC (ns) 55 55 55 54 55 55 Note: CL = CAS latency. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbbDDR2_1.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 1 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Table of Contents Table of Contents Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1 Part Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7 FBGA Part Marking Decoder. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7 General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7 Industrial Temperature. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 General Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 Ball Assignment and Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18 State Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20 Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21 Mode Register (MR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24 Burst Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24 Burst Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25 Operating Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26 DLL RESET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26 Write Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26 Power-Down Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27 CAS Latency (CL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27 Extended Mode Register (EMR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28 DLL Enable/Disable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29 Output Drive Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30 DQS# Enable/Disable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30 RDQS Enable/Disable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30 Output Enable/Disable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30 On-Die Termination (ODT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30 Off-Chip Driver (OCD) Impedance Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31 Posted CAS Additive Latency (AL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31 Extended Mode Register 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 Extended Mode Register 3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 Command Truth Tables. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34 DESELECT, NOP, and LM Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 DESELECT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 NO OPERATION (NOP). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 LOAD MODE (LM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 Bank/Row Activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 ACTIVE Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 ACTIVE Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 READ Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41 READ Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41 WRITE Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 WRITE Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 PRECHARGE Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65 PRECHARGE Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65 SELF REFRESH Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66 REFRESH Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68 Power-Down Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69 Precharge Power-Down Clock Frequency Change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76 RESET Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77 (CKE LOW Anytime) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77 ODT Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79 MRS Command to ODT Update Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80 PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2TOC.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 2 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Table of Contents Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87 Temperature and Thermal Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87 AC and DC Operating Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89 Input Electrical Characteristics and Operating Conditions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 Input Slew Rate Derating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93 Power and Ground Clamp Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 AC Overshoot/Undershoot Specification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Output Electrical Characteristics and Operating Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Full Strength Pull-Down Driver Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Full Strength Pull-Up Driver Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Reduced Strength Pull-Down Driver Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Reduced Strength Pull-Up Driver Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 FBGA Package Capacitance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 IDD Specifications and Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 IDD7 Conditions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 AC Operating Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Package Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2TOC.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 3 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM List of Figures List of Figures Figure 1: Figure 2: Figure 3: Figure 4: Figure 5: Figure 6: Figure 7: Figure 8: Figure 9: Figure 10: Figure 11: Figure 12: Figure 13: Figure 14: Figure 15: Figure 16: Figure 17: Figure 18: Figure 19: Figure 20: Figure 21: Figure 22: Figure 23: Figure 24: Figure 25: Figure 26: Figure 27: Figure 28: Figure 29: Figure 30: Figure 31: Figure 32: Figure 33: Figure 34: Figure 35: Figure 36: Figure 37: Figure 38: Figure 39: Figure 40: Figure 41: Figure 42: Figure 43: Figure 44: Figure 45: Figure 46: Figure 47: Figure 48: Figure 49: Figure 50: Figure 51: Figure 52: Figure 53: Figure 54: Figure 55: Figure 56: 1Gb DDR2 Part Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7 84-Ball FBGA (x16) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9 68-Ball FBGA (x4, x8) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 92-Ball FBGA (x16) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13 92-Ball FBGA (x4/x8) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14 Functional Block Diagram – 64 Meg x 16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18 Functional Block Diagram – 128 Meg x 8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 Functional Block Diagram – 256 Meg x 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 Simplified State Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20 DDR2 Power-up and Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21 Mode Register (MR) Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25 CAS Latency (CL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28 Extended Mode Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29 READ Latency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31 WRITE Latency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 Extended Mode Register 2 (EMR2) Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 Extended Mode Register 3 (EMR3) Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 ACTIVE Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40 8-Bank Activate Restriction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40 READ Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42 Example: Meeting tRRD (MIN) and tRCD (MIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42 READ Latency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43 Consecutive READ Bursts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44 Nonconsecutive READ Bursts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45 READ Interrupted by READ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45 READ-to-PRECHARGE – BL = 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47 READ-to-PRECHARGE – BL = 8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47 READ-to-WRITE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48 Bank Read – without Auto Precharge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49 Bank Read – with Auto Precharge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50 x4, x8 Data Output Timing – tDQSQ, tQH, and Data Valid Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51 x16 Data Output Timing – tDQSQ, tQH, and Data Valid Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52 Data Output Timing – tAC and tDQSCK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53 WRITE Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 WRITE Burst . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56 Consecutive WRITE-to-WRITE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57 Nonconsecutive WRITE-to-WRITE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57 Random WRITE Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58 WRITE Interrupted by WRITE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58 WRITE-to-READ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59 WRITE-to-PRECHARGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60 Bank Write – without Auto Precharge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61 Bank Write – with Auto Precharge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62 WRITE – DM Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63 Data Input Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64 PRECHARGE Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65 Self Refresh. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67 Refresh Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68 Power-Down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70 READ to Power-Down or Self Refresh Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72 READ with Auto Precharge to Power-Down or Self Refresh Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72 WRITE to Power-Down or Self-Refresh Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73 WRITE with Auto Precharge to Power-Down or Self Refresh Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73 REFRESH Command to Power-Down Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74 ACTIVE Command to Power-Down Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74 PRECHARGE Command to Power-Down Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2LOF.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 4 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM List of Figures Figure 57: Figure 58: Figure 59: Figure 60: Figure 61: Figure 62: Figure 63: Figure 64: Figure 65: Figure 66: Figure 67: Figure 68: Figure 69: Figure 70: Figure 71: Figure 72: Figure 73: Figure 74: Figure 75: Figure 76: Figure 77: Figure 78: Figure 79: Figure 80: Figure 81: Figure 82: Figure 83: Figure 84: Figure 85: Figure 86: Figure 87: Figure 88: Figure 89: Figure 90: Figure 91: Figure 92: Figure 93: Figure 94: LOAD MODE Command to Power-Down Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 Input Clock Frequency Change During Precharge Power-Down Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76 RESET Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78 ODT Timing for Entering and Exiting Power-Down Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80 Timing for MRS Command to ODT Update Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80 ODT Timing for Active or Fast-Exit Power-Down Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81 ODT Timing for Slow-Exit or Precharge Power-Down Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82 ODT Turn-off Timings When Entering Power-Down Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83 ODT Turn-On Timing When Entering Power-Down Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84 ODT Turn-Off Timing When Exiting Power-Down Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85 ODT Turn-on Timing When Exiting Power-Down Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86 Example Temperature Test Point Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88 Single-Ended Input Signal Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 Differential Input Signal Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 Nominal Slew Rate for tIS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95 Tangent Line for tIS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96 Nominal Slew Rate for tIH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97 Tangent Line for tIH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98 Nominal Slew Rate for tDS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Tangent Line for tDS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 Nominal Slew Rate for tDH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 Tangent Line for tDH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 AC Input Test Signal Waveform Command/Address Balls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 AC Input Test Signal Waveform for Data with DQS, DQS# (Differential) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 AC Input Test Signal Waveform for Data with DQS (single-ended) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 AC Input Test Signal Waveform (differential) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Input Clamp Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Overshoot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Undershoot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Differential Output Signal Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Output Slew Rate Load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Full Strength Pull-Down Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Full Strength Pull-Up Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Reduced Strength Pull-Down Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Reduced Strength Pull-Up Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 84-Ball FBGA Package – 10mm x 16.5mm (x16) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 68-Ball FBGA Package – 10mm x 16.5mm (x4/x8) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 92-Ball FBGA Package – 11mm x 19mm (x4/x8/x16) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2LOF.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 5 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM List of Tables List of Tables Table 1: Table 2: Table 3: Table 4: Table 5: Table 6: Table 7: Table 8: Table 9: Table 10: Table 11: Table 12: Table 13: Table 14: Table 15: Table 16: Table 17: Table 18: Table 17: Table 18: Table 19: Table 20: Table 21: Table 22: Table 23: Table 24: Table 25: Table 26: Table 27: Table 28: Table 29: Table 30: Table 31: Table 32: Table 33: Table 34: Table 35: Table 36: Table 37: Table 38: Table 39: Table 40: Table 41: Table 42: Table 43: Table 44: Table 45: Table 46: Table 47: Table 48: Table 49: Configuration Addressing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1 Key Timing Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1 84-/68-Ball Descriptions – 256 Meg x 4, 128 Meg x 8, 64 Meg x 16. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11 92-Ball Descriptions – 256 Meg x 4, 128 Meg x 8, 64 Meg x 16. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15 Burst Definition. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26 Truth Table – DDR2 Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34 Truth Table – Current State Bank n – Command to Bank n . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 Truth Table – Current State Bank n – Command to Bank m . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37 Minimum Delay with Auto Precharge Enabled . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38 READ Using Concurrent Auto Precharge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46 WRITE Using Concurrent Auto Precharge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55 CKE Truth Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71 DDR2-400/533 ODT Timing for Active and Fast-Exit Power-Down Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81 DDR2-400/533 ODT Timing for Slow-Exit and Precharge Power-Down Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82 DDR2-400/533 ODT Turn-off Timings When Entering Power-Down Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83 DDR2-400/533 ODT Turn-on Timing When Entering Power-Down Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84 DDR2-400/533 ODT Turn-off Timing When Exiting Power-Down Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85 DDR2-400/533 ODT Turn-On Timing When Exiting Power-Down Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86 Absolute Maximum DC Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87 Temperature Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88 Thermal Impedance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88 Recommended DC Operating Conditions (SSTL_18). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89 ODT DC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89 Input DC Logic Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 Input AC Logic Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 Differential Input Logic Levels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 AC Input Test Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92 DDR2-400/533 Setup and Hold Time Derating Values (tIS and tIH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94 DDR2-667 Setup and Hold Time Derating Values (tIS and tIH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94 DDR2-400/533 tDS, tDH Derating Values with Differential Strobe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99 DDR2-667 tDS, tDH Derating Values with Differential Strobe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Single-Ended DQS Slew Rate Derating Values Using tDSb and tDHb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Single-Ended DQS Slew Rate Fully Derated (DQS, DQ at VREF) at DDR2-667 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Single-Ended DQS Slew Rate Fully Derated (DQS, DQ at VREF) at DDR2-533 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 Single-Ended DQS Slew Rate Fully Derated (DQS, DQ at VREF) at DDR2-400 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 Input Clamp Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Address and Control Balls. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Clock, Data, Strobe, and Mask Balls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Differential AC Output Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Output DC Current Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Output Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Full Strength Pull-Down Current (mA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Full Strength Pull-Up Current (mA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Reduced Strength Pull-Down Current (mA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Reduced Strength Pull-Up Current (mA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Input Capacitance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 DDR2 IDD Specifications and Conditions (continued). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 General IDD Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 IDD7 Timing Patterns (8-bank) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 AC Operating Conditions for -3E, -3, -37E, and -5E Speeds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 AC Operating Conditions for -25E and -25 Speeds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2LOT.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 6 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Part Numbers Part Numbers Figure 1: 1Gb DDR2 Part Numbers Example Part Number: M T47H 128M 8B 7- 37E : D Configuration Package : Speed Revision { MT47H :A/:D Revision Configuration 256 Meg x 4 256M4 128 Meg x 8 128M8 L 64M16 IT Industrial Temperature 64 Meg x 16 Package 92-Ball 11mm x 19mm FBGA BT -5E Speed Grade tCK = 5ns, CL = 3 84-Ball 10mm x 16.5mm FBGA B7 -37E tCK = 3.75ns, CL = 4 68-Ball 10mm x 16.5mm FBGA B7 -3 -3E -25 -25E Note: Low-Power tCK = 3ns, CL = 5 tCK = 3ns, CL = 4 tCK = 2.5ns, CL = 6 tCK = 2.5ns, CL = 5 Not all speeds and configurations are available. Contact Micron sales for current revision. FBGA Part Marking Decoder Due to space limitations, FBGA-packaged components have an abbreviated part marking that is different from the part number. Micron’s FBGA Part Marking Decoder is available at www.micron.com/decoder. General Description The 1Gb DDR2 SDRAM is a high-speed CMOS, dynamic random access memory containing 1,073,741,824 bits. It is internally configured as an 8-bank DRAM. The functional block diagrams of the all device configurations are shown in “Functional Description” on page 18. Ball assignments and signal descriptions are shown in “Ball Assignment and Description” on page 9. The 1Gb DDR2 SDRAM uses a double data rate architecture to achieve high-speed operation. The double data rate architecture is essentially a 4n-prefetch architecture, with an interface designed to transfer two data words per clock cycle at the I/O balls. A single read or write access for the 1Gb DDR2 SDRAM effectively consists of a single 4n-bitwide, one-clock-cycle data transfer at the internal DRAM core and four corresponding n-bit-wide, one-half-clock-cycle data transfers at the I/O balls. A bidirectional data strobe (DQS, DQS#) is transmitted externally, along with data, for use in data capture at the receiver. DQS is a strobe transmitted by the DDR2 SDRAM during READs and by the memory controller during WRITEs. DQS is edge-aligned with data for READs and center-aligned with data for WRITEs. The x16 offering has two data strobes, one for the lower byte (LDQS, LDQS#) and one for the upper byte (UDQS, UDQS#). PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 7 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM General Description The 1Gb DDR2 SDRAM operates from a differential clock (CK and CK#); the crossing of CK going HIGH and CK# going LOW will be referred to as the positive edge of CK. Commands (address and control signals) are registered at every positive edge of CK. Input data is registered on both edges of DQS, and output data is referenced to both edges of DQS as well as to both edges of CK. Read and write accesses to the DDR2 SDRAM are burst-oriented; accesses start at a selected location and continue for a programmed number of locations in a programmed sequence. Accesses begin with the registration of an ACTIVE command, which is then followed by a READ or WRITE command. The address bits registered coincident with the ACTIVE command are used to select the bank and row to be accessed. The address bits registered coincident with the READ or WRITE command are used to select the bank and the starting column location for the burst access. The DDR2 SDRAM provides for programmable read or write burst lengths of four or eight locations. DDR2 SDRAM supports interrupting a burst read of eight with another read or a burst write of eight with another write. An auto precharge function may be enabled to provide a self-timed row precharge that is initiated at the end of the burst access. As with standard DDR SDRAMs, the pipelined, multibank architecture of DDR2 SDRAMs allows for concurrent operation, thereby providing high, effective bandwidth by hiding row precharge and activation time. A self refresh mode is provided, along with a power-saving, power-down mode. All inputs are compatible with the JEDEC standard for SSTL_18. All full drive-strength outputs are SSTL_18-compatible. Industrial Temperature The industrial temperature (IT) device has two simultaneous requirements: ambient temperature surrounding the device cannot exceed –40°C or +85°C, and the case temperature cannot exceed –40°C or 95°C. JEDEC specifications require the refresh rate to double when TC exceeds 85°C; this also requires use of the high-temperature self refresh option. Additionally, ODT resistance and the input/output impedance must be derated when the TC is < 0°C or > 85°C. General Notes • The functionality and the timing specifications discussed in this data sheet are for the DLL-enabled mode of operation. • Throughout the data sheet, the various figures and text refer to DQs as “DQ.” The DQ term is to be interpreted as any and all DQ collectively, unless specifically stated otherwise. Additionally, the x16 is divided into 2 bytes, the lower byte and upper byte. For the lower byte (DQ0–DQ7), DM refers to LDM and DQS refers to LDQS. For the upper byte (DQ8–DQ15), DM refers to UDM and DQS refers to UDQS. • Complete functionality is described throughout the document, and any page or diagram may have been simplified to convey a topic and may not be inclusive of all requirements. • Any specific requirement takes precedence over a general statement. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 8 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Ball Assignment and Description Ball Assignment and Description Figure 2: 84-Ball FBGA (x16) 10mm x 16.5mm (top view) A B C D E F G H J 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 VDD NC VSS DQ14 VSSQ UDM UDQS VSSQ DQ15 VDDQ DQ9 VDDQ VDDQ DQ8 VDDQ DQ12 VSSQ DQ11 DQ10 VSSQ DQ13 VDD NC VSS DQ6 VSSQ LDM LDQS VSSQ DQ7 VDDQ DQ1 VDDQ VDDQ DQ0 VDDQ DQ4 VSSQ DQ3 DQ2 VSSQ DQ5 VDDL VREF VSS VSSDL CK VDD CKE WE# RAS# CK# ODT BA0 BA1 CAS# CS# A10 A1 A2 A0 A3 A5 A6 A4 A7 A9 A11 A8 A12 RFU RFU RFU VSSQ UDQS#/NU VDDQ VSSQ LDQS#/NU VDDQ K L RFU M VDD N VSS P VSS R VDD PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 9 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Ball Assignment and Description Figure 3: 68-Ball FBGA (x4, x8) 10mm x 16.5mm (top view) 1 2 NC NC 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 NC NC A B C D E VDD NU/RDQS# VSSQ DQS#/NU VDDQ VSS F NF, DQ6 VSSQ DM/RDQS DQS VDDQ DQ1 VDDQ VDDQ VSSQ NF,DQ7 G DQ0 VDDQ H NF, DQ4 VSSQ DQ3 DQ2 VSSQ NF, DQ5 VREF VSS VSSDL CK VDD CKE WE# RAS# CK# ODT BA0 BA1 CAS# CS# A10 A1 A2 A0 A3 A5 A6 A4 A7 A9 A11 A8 VDD A12 RFU RFU A13 NC NC J VDDL K L BA2 M VDD N VSS P VSS R T U V W PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN NC 10 NC Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Ball Assignment and Description Table 3: 84-/68-Ball Descriptions – 256 Meg x 4, 128 Meg x 8, 64 Meg x 16 x16 Ball Number x4, x8 Ball Number Symbol K9 K9 ODT J8, K8 J8, K8 CK, CK# K2 K2 CKE L8 L8 CS# K7, L7, K3 F3, B3 K7, L7, K3 F3 RAS#, CAS#, WE# LDM, UDM (DM) L2, L3, L1 L2, L3, L1 BA0–BA2 M8, M3, M7, N2, N8, N3, N7, P2, P8, P3, M2, P7, R2 M8, M3, M7, N2, N8, N3, N7, P2, P8, P3, M2, P7, R2 R8 A0–A2, A3–A5, A6–A7, A8–A10, A11–A12 A13 (x4, x8) PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Type Description Input On-die termination: ODT (registered HIGH) enables termination resistance internal to the DDR2 SDRAM. When enabled, ODT is only applied to each of the following balls: DQ0–DQ15, LDM, UDM, LDQS, LDQS#, UDQS, and UDQS# for the x16; DQ0–DQ7, DQS, DQS#, RDQS, RDQS#, and DM for the x8; DQ0–DQ3, DQS, DQS#, and DM for the x4. The ODT input will be ignored if disabled via the LOAD MODE command. Input Clock: CK and CK# are differential clock inputs. All address and control input signals are sampled on the crossing of the positive edge of CK and negative edge of CK#. Output data (DQs and DQS/DQS#) is referenced to the crossings of CK and CK#. Input Clock enable: CKE (registered HIGH) activates and CKE (registered LOW) deactivates clocking circuitry on the DDR2 SDRAM. The specific circuitry that is enabled/disabled is dependent on the DDR2 SDRAM configuration and operating mode. CKE LOW provides precharge power-down mode and SELF REFRESH operation (all banks idle), or active power-down (row active in any bank). CKE is synchronous for power-down entry, power-down exit, output disable, and for self refresh entry. CKE is asynchronous for SELF REFRESH exit. Input buffers (excluding CK, CK#, CKE, and ODT) are disabled during power-down. Input buffers (excluding CKE) are disabled during self refresh. CKE is an SSTL_18 input but will detect a LVCMOS LOW level once VDD is applied during first power-up. After VREF has become stable during the power on and initialization sequence, it must be maintained for proper operation of the CKE receiver. For proper SELF REFRESH operation, VREF must be maintained. Input Chip select: CS# enables (registered LOW) and disables (registered HIGH) the command decoder. All commands are masked when CS# is registered HIGH. CS# provides for external bank selection on systems with multiple ranks. CS# is considered part of the command code. Input Command inputs: RAS#, CAS#, and WE# (along with CS#) define the command being entered. Input Input data mask: DM is an input mask signal for write data. Input data is masked when DM is concurrently sampled HIGH during a WRITE access. DM is sampled on both edges of DQS. Although DM balls are input-only, the DM loading is designed to match that of DQ and DQS balls. LDM is DM for lower byte DQ0–DQ7 and UDM is DM for upper byte DQ8–DQ15. Input Bank address inputs: BA0–BA2 define to which bank an ACTIVE, READ, WRITE, or PRECHARGE command is being applied. BA0–BA2 define which mode register, including MR, EMR, EMR(2), and EMR(3), is loaded during the LOAD MODE command. Input Address inputs: Provide the row address for ACTIVE commands, and the column address and auto precharge bit (A10) for READ/WRITE commands, to select one location out of the memory array in the respective bank. A10 sampled during a PRECHARGE command determines whether the PRECHARGE applies to one bank (A10 LOW, bank selected by BA2–BA0) or all banks (A10 HIGH). The address inputs also provide the op-code during a LOAD MODE command. 11 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Ball Assignment and Description Table 3: x16 Ball Number 84-/68-Ball Descriptions – 256 Meg x 4, 128 Meg x 8, 64 Meg x 16 (Continued) x4, x8 Ball Number Symbol G8, G2, H7, H3, – DQ0–DQ3, H1, H9, F1, F9, DQ4–DQ7, C8, C2, D7, DQ8–DQ10, D3, D1, D9, DQ11–DQ13, B1, B9 DQ14–DQ15 – G8, G2, H7, H3, DQ0–DQ3 H1, H9, F1, F9 DQ4–DQ7 – G8, G2, H7, H3 DQ0–DQ2 DQ3 B7 – UDQS, A8 UDQS# F7 E8 – – Type Description I/O Data input/output: Bidirectional data bus for 64 Meg x 16. I/O Data input/output: Bidirectional data bus for 128 Meg x 8. I/O Data input/output: Bidirectional data bus for 256 Meg x 4. I/O Data strobe for upper byte: Output with read data, input with write data for source synchronous operation. Edge-aligned with read data, center-aligned with write data. UDQS# is only used when differential data strobe mode is enabled via the LOAD MODE command. – LDQS, LDQS# I/O Data strobe for lower byte: Output with read data, input with write data for source synchronous operation. Edge-aligned with read data, center-aligned with write data. LDQS# is only used when differential data strobe mode is enabled via the LOAD MODE command. F7, E8 DQS, DQS# I/O Data strobe: Output with read data, input with write data for source synchronous operation. Edge-aligned with read data, center-aligned with write data. DQS# is only used when differential data strobe mode is enabled via the LOAD MODE command. F3, E2 RDQS, RDQS# Output Redundant data strobe for 128 Meg x 8 only. RDQS is enabled/ disabled via the LOAD MODE command to the extended mode register (EMR). When RDQS is enabled, RDQS is output with read data only and is ignored during write data. When RDQS is disabled, ball F3 becomes data mask (see DM ball). RDQS# is only used when RDQS is enabled and differential data strobe mode is enabled. E1, J9, M9, R1 VDD Supply Power supply: 1.8V ±0.1V. A1, E1, J9, M9, R1 J1 J1 A9, C1, C3, C7, E9, G1, G3, G7, C9, E9, G1, G3, G9 G7, G9 J2 J2 A3, E3, J3, N1, J3, E3, N1, P9 P9 J7 J7 A7, B2, B8, D2, E7, F2, F8, H2, D8, E7, F2, F8, H8 H2, H8 A2, E2 W1, W2, W8, W9, A1, A2, A8, A9 A8, E8 – VDDL VDDQ VREF VSS VSSDL VSSQ Supply DLL power supply: 1.8V ±0.1V. Supply DQ power supply: 1.8V ±0.1V. Isolated on the device for improved noise immunity. Supply SSTL_18 reference voltage. Supply Ground. Supply DLL ground. Isolated on the device from VSS and VSSQ. Supply DQ ground. Isolated on the device for improved noise immunity. NC – No connect: These balls should be left unconnected. NU – – E2, E8 NU – – F1, F9, H1, H9, E2 R3, R7 NF – Not used: Not used only on x16. If EMR[E10] = 0, A8 and E8 are UDQS# and LDQS#. If EMR[E10] = 1, then A8 and E8 are not used. Not used: Not used only on x8. If EMR[E10] = 0, E2 and E8 are RDQS# and DQS#. If EMR[E10] = 1, then E2 and E8 are not used. Not funtion: Not used only on x4. These are data lines on the x8. RFU – Reserved for future use: Row address bits A14 (R3) and A13 (R8). R8, R3, R7 PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 12 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Ball Assignment and Description Figure 4: 92-Ball FBGA (x16) 11mm x 19mm top (view) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 NC NC NC NC VDD NC VSS DQ14 VSSQ UDM UDQS VSSQ DQ15 VDDQ DQ9 VDDQ VDDQ DQ8 VDDQ DQ12 VSSQ DQ11 DQ10 VSSQ DQ13 VDD NC VSS DQ6 VSSQ LDM LDQS VSSQ DQ7 VDDQ DQ1 VDDQ VDDQ DQ0 VDDQ DQ4 VSSQ DQ3 DQ2 VSSQ DQ5 VDDL VREF VSS VSSDL CK VDD CKE WE# RAS# CK# ODT BA0 BA1 CAS# CS# A10 A1 A2 A0 A3 A5 A6 A4 A7 A9 A11 A8 VDD A12 RFU RFU RFU NC NC A B C D VSSQ UDQS#/NU VDDQ E F G H VSSQ LDQS#/NU VDDQ J K L M N P BA2 R VDD T VSS U VSS V W Y AA PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN NC 13 NC Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Ball Assignment and Description Figure 5: 92-Ball FBGA (x4/x8) 11mm x 19mm top (view) 1 2 3 NC NC V DD NC V SS NC NC NC NC 4 5 6 7 8 9 NC NC V SS Q NC V DD Q NC NC NC NC NC NC NC NC NC NC NC NC NC NC A B C D E F G H V DD NF, RDQS#/NU V SS Q DQS#/NU V SS V DD Q J NF, DQ6 V SS Q DM/RDQS DQS V SS Q NF, DQ7 V DD Q DQ1 VDDQ V DD Q DQ0 V DD Q NF,DQ 4 V SS Q DQ3 DQ2 V SS Q NF, DQ5 VDD L V REF V SS V SS DL CK VDD CKE WE# RAS# CK# ODT BA0 BA1 CAS# CS# A10 A1 A2 A0 A3 A5 A6 A4 A7 A9 A11 A8 V DD A12 RFU RFU A13 NC NC K L M N P BA2 R V DD T V SS U V SS V W Y AA PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN NC 14 NC Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Ball Assignment and Description Table 4: 92-Ball Descriptions – 256 Meg x 4, 128 Meg x 8, 64 Meg x 16 x16 Ball Number x4, x8 Ball Number Symbol Type Description N9 N9 ODT Input M8, N8 M8, N8 CK, CK# Input N2 N2 CKE Input P8 P8 CS# Input N7, P7, N3 J3, E3 N7, P7, N3 Input J3 RAS#, CAS#, WE# LDM, UDM, (DM) P2, P3, P1 P2, P3, P1 BA0–BA2 Input R8, R3, R7, T2, T8, T3, T7, U2, U8, U3, R2, U7, V2 – A0–A2, A3–A6, A7–A9, A10–A12 Input On-die termination: ODT (registered HIGH) enables termination resistance internal to the DDR2 SDRAM. When enabled, ODT is only applied to each of the following balls: DQ0–DQ15, LDM, UDM, LDQS, LDQS#, UDQS, and UDQS# for the x16; DQ0–DQ7, DQS, DQS#, RDQS, RDQS#, and DM for the x8; DQ0–DQ3, DQS, DQS#, and DM for the x4. The ODT input will be ignored if disabled via the LOAD MODE command. Clock: CK and CK# are differential clock inputs. All address and control input signals are sampled on the crossing of the positive edge of CK and negative edge of CK#. Output data (DQs and DQS/ DQS#) is referenced to the crossings of CK and CK#. Clock enable: CKE (registered HIGH) activates and CKE (registered LOW) deactivates clocking circuitry on the DDR2 SDRAM. The specific circuitry that is enabled/disabled is dependent on the DDR2 SDRAM configuration and operating mode. CKE LOW provides precharge power-down mode and SELF REFRESH operation (all banks idle), or active power-down (row active in any bank). CKE is synchronous for power-down entry, power-down exit, output disable, and self refresh entry. CKE is asynchronous for SELF REFRESH exit. Input buffers (excluding CK, CK#, CKE, and ODT) are disabled during power-down. Input buffers (excluding CKE) are disabled during self refresh. CKE is an SSTL_18 input but will detect a LVCMOS LOW level once VDD is applied during first power-up. After VREF has become stable during the power on and initialization sequence, it must be maintained for proper operation of the CKE receiver. For proper SELF REFRESH operation, VREF must be maintained. Chip select: CS# enables (registered LOW) and disables (registered HIGH) the command decoder. All commands are masked when CS# is registered HIGH. CS# provides for external bank selection on systems with multiple ranks. CS# is considered part of the command code. Command inputs: RAS#, CAS#, and WE# (along with CS#) define the command being entered. Input data mask: DM is an input mask signal for write data. Input data is masked when DM is concurrently sampled HIGH during a WRITE access. DM is sampled on both edges of DQS. Although DM balls are input-only, the DM loading is designed to match that of DQ and DQS balls. LDM is DM for lower byte DQ0–DQ7 and UDM is DM for upper byte DQ8–DQ15. Bank address inputs: BA0–BA2 define to which bank an ACTIVE, READ, WRITE, or PRECHARGE command is being applied. BA0–BA2 define which mode register including MR, EMR, EMR(2), and EMR(3) is loaded during the LOAD MODE command. Address inputs: Provide the row address for ACTIVE commands, and the column address and auto precharge bit (A10) for READ/ WRITE commands, to select one location out of the memory array in the respective bank. A10 sampled during a PRECHARGE command determines whether the PRECHARGE applies to one bank (A10 LOW, bank selected by BA2–BA0) or all banks (A10 HIGH). The address inputs also provide the op-code during a LOAD MODE command. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Input 15 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Ball Assignment and Description Table 4: 92-Ball Descriptions – 256 Meg x 4, 128 Meg x 8, 64 Meg x 16 x16 Ball Number x4, x8 Ball Number Symbol Type Description – R8, R3, R7, T2, T8, T3, T7, U2, U8, U3, R2, U7, V2, V8 A0–A3, A4–A7, A8–A10, A11–A13 Input I/O Address inputs: Provide the row address for ACTIVE commands, and the column address and auto precharge bit (A10) for READ/ WRITE commands, to select one location out of the memory array in the respective bank. A10 sampled during a PRECHARGE command determines whether the PRECHARGE applies to one bank (A10 LOW, bank selected by BA2–BA0) or all banks (A10 HIGH). The address inputs also provide the op-code during a LOAD MODE command. Data input/output: Bidirectional data bus for 64 Meg x 16. I/O Data input/output: Bidirectional data bus for 128 Meg x 8. K8, K2, L7, L3, – DQ0–DQ3, L1, L9, J1, J9, DQ4–DQ7, F8, F2, G7, DQ8–DQ10, G3, G1, G9, DQ11–DQ13, E1, E9 DQ14–DQ15 – K8, K2, L7, L3, DQ0–DQ3, L1, L9, J1, J9 DQ4–DQ7 – K8, K2, L7, L3 DQ0–DQ3 E7, – UDQS, D8 UDQS# J7, H8 – – J7, H8 – J3, H2 D1, H1, M9, R9, V1 M1 D9, F1, F3, F7, F9, H9, K1, K3, K7, K9 M2 D3, H3, M3, T1, U9 M7 D7, E2, E8, G2, G8, H7, J2, J8, L2, L8 D1, H1, M9, R9, V1 M1 D9, H9, K1, K3, K7, K9 M2 D3, H3, M3, T1, U9 M7 D7, H7,J 2, J8, L2, L8 PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN I/O I/O Data input/output: Bidirectional data bus for 256 Meg x 4. Data strobe for upper byte: Output with read data, input with write data for source synchronous operation. Edge-aligned with read data, center-aligned with write data. UDQS# is only used when differential data strobe mode is enabled via the LOAD MODE command. LDQS, I/O Data strobe for lower byte: Output with read data, input with LDQS# write data for source synchronous operation. Edge-aligned with read data, center-aligned with write data. LDQS# is only used when differential data strobe mode is enabled via the LOAD MODE command. DQS, DQS# I/O Data strobe: Output with read data, input with write data for source synchronous operation. Edge-aligned with read data, center-aligned with write data. DQS# is only used when differential data strobe mode is enabled via the LOAD MODE command. RDQS, RDQS# Output Redundant data strobe for 128 Meg x 8 only. RDQS is enabled/ disabled via the LOAD MODE command to the extended mode register (EMR). When RDQS is enabled, RDQS is output with read data only and is ignored during write data. When RDQS is disabled, ball J3 becomes data mask (see DM ball). RDQS# is only used when RDQS is enabled and differential data strobe mode is enabled. Supply Power Supply: 1.8V ±0.1V. VDD VDDL VDDQ VREF VSS VSSDL VSSQ Supply DLL Power supply: 1.8V ±0.1V. Supply DQ Power supply: 1.8V ±0.1V. Isolated on the device for improved noise immunity. Supply SSTL_18 reference voltage. Supply Ground. Supply DLL ground: Isolated on the device from VSS and VSSQ. Supply DQ ground: Isolated on the device for improved noise immunity. 16 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Ball Assignment and Description Table 4: 92-Ball Descriptions – 256 Meg x 4, 128 Meg x 8, 64 Meg x 16 x16 Ball Number x4, x8 Ball Number A1, A2, A8, A9 D2, H2, AA1, AA2, AA8, AA9 D8, H8 A1, A2, A8, A9, D2, D8, E1–E3, E7–E9, F1–F3, F7–F9, G1–G3, G7–G9, AA1, AA2, AA8, AA9 J1, J9, L1, L9, H2, – – V3, V7, V8 – Symbol Type NC – No connect: These balls should be left unconnected. NF – NU – H2, H8 NU – V3, V7 RFU – No function: These balls are used as DQ4–DQ7 on the 128 Meg x8 , but are NF (no function) on the 256 Meg x 4 configuration. Not used: Not used only on x16. If EMR[E10] = 0, D8 and H8 are UDQS# and LDQS#. If EMR[E10] = 1, then D8 and H8 are not used. Not used: Not used only on x8. If EMR[E10] = 0, H2 and H8 are RDQS# and DQS#. If EMR[E10] = 1, then H2 and H8 are not used. Reserved for future use: Row address bits A13 (V8), A14(V3), and A15(V7) are reserved. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Description 17 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Functional Description Functional Description The 1Gb DDR2 SDRAM is a high-speed CMOS dynamic random access memory containing 1,073,741,824 bits. The 1Gb DDR2 SDRAM is internally configured as an 8bank DRAM. The 1Gb DDR2 SDRAM uses a double data rate architecture to achieve high-speed operation. The DDR2 architecture is essentially a 4n-prefetch architecture, with an interface designed to transfer two data words per clock cycle at the I/O balls. A single read or write access for the 1Gb DDR2 SDRAM consists of a single 4n-bit-wide, one-clock-cycle data transfer at the internal DRAM core and four corresponding n-bit- wide, one-half-clockcycle data transfers at the I/O balls. Prior to normal operation, the DDR2 SDRAM must be initialized. The following sections provide detailed information covering device initialization, register definition, command descriptions, and device operation. Figure 9 on page 20 shows a simplified state diagram to provide the basic command flow. It is not comprehensive and does not identify all timing requirements or possible command restrictions. Figure 6: Functional Block Diagram – 64 Meg x 16 ODT CS# RAS# CAS# WE# CONTROL LOGIC COMMAND DECODE CKE CK CK# 13 MODE REGISTERS 16 REFRESH 13 COUNTER ROWADDRESS MUX BANK 7 BANK 7 BANK 6 BANK 6 BANK 5 BANK 5 BANK 4 BANK 4 BANK 3 BANK 3 BANK 2 BANK 2 BANK 1 BANK 1 BANK 0 BANK 0 ROWMEMORY ADDRESS ARRAY LATCH 8,192 & (8,192 x 256 x 64) DECODER 13 64 READ LATCH 3 10 BANK CONTROL LOGIC COLUMNADDRESS COUNTER/ LATCH sw1 16 DRVRS MUX DATA 64 UDQS, UDQS# INPUT LDQS, LDQS# REGISTERS 2 2 2 8 WRITE 2 FIFO MASK 2 & 64 DRIVERS 16 COLUMN DECODER CK,CK# 2 CK OUT 64 16 CK IN DATA 16 16 sw2 sw3 R1 R2 R3 R1 R2 R3 sw1 sw2 sw3 DQ0–DQ15 4 DQS GENERATOR 256 (x64) 8 16 16 ODT CONTROL VDDQ sw1 sw2 sw3 DLL 16 I/O GATING DM MASK LOGIC 2 16 ADDRESS REGISTER 16 SENSE AMPLIFIERS 16,384 A0–A12, BA0–BA2 CK,CK# COL0,COL1 2 2 2 2 R1 R2 R3 R1 R2 R3 sw1 sw2 sw3 UDQS, UDQS# LDQS, LDQS# RCVRS 16 16 16 16 R1 R2 R3 16 R1 R2 R3 UDM, LDM 4 COL0,COL1 VssQ PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 18 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Functional Description Figure 7: Functional Block Diagram – 128 Meg x 8 ODT CKE CK CK# COMMAND DECODE CONTROL LOGIC CS# RAS# CAS# WE# 14 MODE REGISTERS 17 REFRESH 14 COUNTER 14 ROWADDRESS MUX BANK 7 BANK 7 BANK 6 BANK 6 BANK 5 BANK 5 BANK 4 BANK 4 BANK 3 BANK 3 BANK 2 BANK 2 BANK 1 BANK 1 BANK 0 BANK 0 ROWMEMORY ADDRESS ARRAY LATCH 16,384 & (16,384 x 256 x 32) DECODER 32 READ LATCH BANK CONTROL LOGIC 3 COLUMNADDRESS COUNTER/ LATCH 10 8 sw1 8 8 8 MUX 2 2 4 WRITE 2 FIFO MASK 2 & 32 DRIVERS 8 CK,CK# 2 sw2 sw3 R1 R2 R3 R1 R2 R3 sw1 sw2 sw3 DQ0–DQ7 2 UDQS, UDQS# INPUT LDQS, LDQS# REGISTERS 2 2 32 COLUMN DECODER DRVRS DATA DQS GENERATOR 256 (x32) ODT CONTROL VDDQ sw1 sw2 sw3 DLL 8 I/O GATING DM MASK LOGIC 2 17 ADDRESS REGISTER 8 SENSE AMPLIFIERS 8,192 A0-A13, BA0-BA2 CK,CK# COL0,COL1 2 2 R1 R2 R3 R1 R2 R3 DQS, DQS# RDQS# 2 RCVRS 8 CK OUT 32 8 CK IN DATA 8 8 8 8 8 8 sw1 sw2 sw3 R1 R2 R3 R1 R2 R3 RDQS DM 2 COL0,COL1 VssQ Figure 8: Functional Block Diagram – 256 Meg x 4 ODT CS# RAS# CAS# WE# CONTROL LOGIC COMMAND DECODE CKE CK CK# 14 MODE REGISTERS 17 REFRESH 14 COUNTER 14 ROWADDRESS MUX BANK 7 BANK 7 BANK 6 BANK 6 BANK 5 BANK 5 BANK 4 BANK 4 BANK 3 BANK 3 BANK 2 BANK 2 BANK 1 BANK 1 BANK 0 BANK 0 ROWMEMORY ADDRESS ARRAY LATCH 16,384 & (16,384 x 512 x 16) DECODER 16 READ LATCH 3 11 BANK CONTROL LOGIC COLUMNADDRESS COUNTER/ LATCH 9 sw1 4 4 4 MUX DRVRS DATA DQS, DQS# INPUT REGISTERS 1 1 16 1 4 WRITE 1 FIFO MASK 1 & 16 DRIVERS 4 COLUMN DECODER CK,CK# 2 CK OUT 16 4 CK IN DATA 4 4 sw2 sw3 R1 R2 R3 R1 R2 R3 sw1 sw2 sw3 DQ0–DQ3 2 DQS GENERATOR 512 (x16) ODT CONTROL VDDQ sw1 sw2 sw3 DLL 4 I/O GATING DM MASK LOGIC 2 17 ADDRESS REGISTER 4 SENSE AMPLIFIERS 8,192 A0-A13, BA0-BA2 CK,CK# COL0,COL1 1 1 1 1 R1 R2 R3 R1 R2 R3 sw1 sw2 sw3 DQS, DQS# RCVRS 4 4 4 4 R1 R2 R3 4 R1 R2 R3 DM 2 COL0,COL1 VssQ PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 19 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM State Diagram State Diagram Figure 9 shows a simplified state diagram to provide the basic command flow. It is not comprehensive and does not identify all timing requirements or possible command restrictions. Figure 9: Simplified State Diagram CKE_L Initialization Sequence OCD calibration Self Refreshing SR PRE E_H CK Setting MRS EMRS Idle All banks Precharged (E)MRS REFRESH CK E_ H Refreshing L CK E_ L E_ CK Precharge PowerDown CKE_L Automatic Sequence Command Sequence ACT = Activate CKE_H = CKE HIGH, exit power-down or self refresh CKE_L = CKE LOW, enter power-down (E)MRS = (Extended) mode register set PRE = PRECHARGE PRE_A = PRECHARGE ALL READ = READ RD_A = READ with auto precharge REFRESH = REFRESH SR = SELF REFRESH WRITE = WRITE WR_A = WRITE with auto precharge ACT CKE_L Activating _L CKE Active PowerDown CK CKE_ E_L H Bank Active E R_ A W W RE AD _A RD RIT WRITE Writing READ READ Reading WR_A RD _A _A RD_A PR E , PRE, PRE_A PR A E_ PR Writing with Auto Precharge E_ A E, PR WR_A WR Reading with Auto Precharge Precharging PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 20 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Initialization DDR2 SDRAMs must be powered up and initialized in a predefined manner. Operational procedures other than those specified may result in undefined operation. Figure 10 illustrates the sequence required for power-up and initialization. Figure 10: DDR2 Power-up and Initialization Notes appear on page 22 VDD VDDL VDDQ tVTD1 VTT1 VREF T0 tCK Ta0 Tb0 Tc0 Td0 Te0 Tf0 Tg0 Th0 Ti0 Tj0 Tk0 Tl0 NOP5 PRE LM7 LM8 LM9 LM10 PRE11 REF12 REF LM13 LM14 LM15 A10 = 1 CODE CODE CODE CODE A10 = 1 Tm0 CK# CK tCL tCL SSTL_18 LVCMOS CKE LOW LEVEL2 LOW LEVEL2 ODT 21 COMMAND3 VALID16 ADDRESS3 DQS4 High-Z DQ4 High-Z RTT High-Z T = 200µs (MIN) Power-up: VDD and stable clock (CK, CK#) T = 400ns (MIN)6 tRPA tMRD tMRD tMRD tMRD CODE tRPA tRFC tRFC CODE CODE tMRD tMRD VALID tMRD See note 12 EMR(2) EMR(3) EMR MR without DLL RESET MR with DLL RESET EMR with OCD Default EMR with OCD Exit 200 cycles of CK are required before a READ command can be issued. Indicates a break in time scale Normal Operation DON’T CARE 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Initialization Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. DM4 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Initialization Notes: 1. Applying power; if CKE is maintained below 0.2 x VDDQ, outputs remain disabled. To guarantee RTT (ODT resistance) is off, VREF must be valid and a low level must be applied to the ODT ball (all other inputs may be undefined; I/Os and outputs must be less than VDDQ during voltage ramp time to avoid DDR2 SDRAM device latch-up). VTT is not applied directly to the device; however, tVTT should be ≥0 to avoid device latch-up. At least one of the following two sets of conditions (A or B) must be met to obtain a stable supply state (stable supply defined as VDD, VDDL, VDDQ, VREF, and VTT are between their minimum and maximum values as stated in Table 20 on page 89): 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN A. Single power source: The VDD voltage ramp from 300mV to VDD (MIN) must take no longer than 200ms; during the VDD voltage ramp, |VDD - VDDQ| ≤ 0.3V. Once supply voltage ramping is complete (when VDDQ crosses VDD [MIN]), Table 20 specifications apply. • VDD, VDDL, and VDDQ are driven from a single power converter output • VTT is limited to 0.95V MAX • VREF tracks VDDQ/2; VREF must be within ±0.3V with respect to VDDQ/2 during supply ramp time • VDDQ ≥ VREF at all times B. Multiple power sources: VDD ≥ VDDL ≥ VDDQ must be maintained during supply voltage ramping, for both AC and DC levels, until supply voltage ramping completes (VDDQ crosses VDD [MIN]). Once supply voltage ramping is complete, Table 20 specifications apply. • Apply VDD and VDDL before or at the same time as VDDQ; VDD/VDDL voltage ramp time must be ≤200ms from when VDD ramps from 300mV to VDD (MIN) • Apply VDDQ before or at the same time as VTT; the VDDQ voltage ramp time from when VDD (MIN) is achieved to when VDDQ (MIN) is achieved must be ≤500ms; while VDD is ramping, current can be supplied from VDD through the device to VDDQ • VREF must track VDDQ/2; VREF must be within ±0.3V with respect to VDDQ/2 during supply ramp time; VDDQ ≥ VREF must be met at all times • Apply VTT; the VTT voltage ramp time from when VDDQ (MIN) is achieved to when VTT (MIN) is achieved must be no greater than 500ms CKE uses LVCMOS input levels prior to state T0 to ensure DQs are High-Z during device power-up prior to VREF being stable. After state T0, CKE is required to have SSTL_18 input levels. Once CKE transitions to a high level, it must stay HIGH for the duration of the initialization sequence. PRE = PRECHARGE command, LM = LOAD MODE command, MR = Mode Register, EMR = extended mode register, EMR2 = extended mode register 2, EMR3 = extended mode register 3, REF = REFRESH command, ACT = ACTIVE command, A10 = PRECHARGE ALL, CODE = desired values for mode registers (bank addresses are required to be decoded), VALID - any valid command/address, RA = row address, bank address. DM represents DM for x4, x8 configurations and UDM, LDM for x16 configuration; DQS represents DQS, DQS#, UDQS, UDQS#, LDQS, LDQS#, RDQS, RDQS# for the appropriate configuration (x4, x8, x16); DQ represents DQ0–DQ3 for x4, DQ–DQ7 for x8, and DQ0–DQ15 for x16. For a minimum of 200µs after stable power and clock (CK, CK#), apply NOP or DESELECT commands, then take CKE HIGH. Wait a minimum of 400ns, then issue a PRECHARGE ALL command. Issue a LOAD MODE command to the EMR(2). (To issue an EMR(2) command, provide LOW to BA2 and BA0, and provide HIGH to BA1.) Set register E7 to “0” or “1;” all others must be “0.” Issue a LOAD MODE command to the EMR(3). (To issue an EMR(3) command, provide HIGH to BA0 =1, BA1 = 1, and BA2 = 0.) Set all registers to “0.” Issue a LOAD MODE command to the EMR to enable DLL. To issue a DLL ENABLE command, provide LOW to BA1, BA2, and A0; provide HIGH to BA0. Bits E7, E8, and E9 can be set to “0” or “1;” Micron recommends setting them to “0.” Issue a LOAD MODE command for DLL RESET. 200 cycles of clock input is required to lock the DLL. (To issue a DLL RESET, provide HIGH to A8 and provide LOW to BA2 = BA1 = BA0 = 0.) CKE must be HIGH the entire time. Issue PRECHARGE ALL command. Issue two or more REFRESH commands. 22 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Initialization 13. Issue a LOAD MODE command with LOW to A8 to initialize device operation (i.e., to program operating parameters without resetting the DLL). To access the mode registers, BA0 = 0, BA1 = 0, BA2 = 0. 14. Issue a LOAD MODE command to the EMR to enable OCD default by setting bits E7, E8, and E9 to “1,” and then setting all other desired parameters. To access the extended mode register, BA2 = 0, BA1 = 0, BA0 = 1. 15. Issue a LOAD MODE command to the EMR to enable OCD exit by setting bits E7, E8, and E9 to “0,” and then setting all other desired parameters. To access the extended mode registers, BA2 = 0, BA1 = 0, BA0 = 1. 16. The DDR2 SDRAM is now initialized and ready for normal operation 200 clock cycles after the DLL RESET at Tf0. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 23 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Mode Register (MR) Mode Register (MR) The mode register is used to define the specific mode of operation of the DDR2 SDRAM. This definition includes the selection of a burst length, burst type, CAS latency, operating mode, DLL RESET, write recovery, and power-down mode, as shown in Figure 11 on page 25. Contents of the mode register can be altered by re-executing the LOAD MODE (LM) command. If the user chooses to modify only a subset of the MR variables, all variables (M0–M13 for x4 and x8 or M0–M12 for x16) must be programmed when the command is issued. The MR is programmed via the LM command (bits BA2–BA0 = 0, 0, 0) and other bits (M13–M0 for x4 and x8, M12–M0 for x16) will retain the stored information until it is programmed again or the device loses power (except for bit M8, which is self-clearing). Reprogramming the mode register will not alter the contents of the memory array, provided it is performed correctly. The LM command can only be issued (or reissued) when all banks are in the precharged state (idle state) and no bursts are in progress. The controller must wait the specified time tMRD before initiating any subsequent operations such as an ACTIVE command. Violating either of these requirements will result in unspecified operation. Burst Length Burst length is defined by bits M0–M3, as shown in Figure 11 on page 25. Read and write accesses to the DDR2 SDRAM are burst-oriented, with the burst length being programmable to either four or eight. The burst length determines the maximum number of column locations that can be accessed for a given READ or WRITE command. When a READ or WRITE command is issued, a block of columns equal to the burst length is effectively selected. All accesses for that burst take place within this block, meaning that the burst will wrap within the block if a boundary is reached. The block is uniquely selected by A2–Ai when BL = 4 and by A3–Ai when BL = 8 (where Ai is the most significant column address bit for a given configuration). The remaining (least significant) address bit(s) is (are) used to select the starting location within the block. The programmed burst length applies to both READ and WRITE bursts. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 24 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Mode Register (MR) Figure 11: Mode Register (MR) Definition BA2 BA1 BA0 A13 A12 A11 A10 A9 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 MR 01 PD WR 9 8 Slow Exit (Low Power) 6 5 4 3 2 Notes: 0 Mode Register (Mx) M2 M1 M0 Burst Length M7 Mode 0 Normal 0 0 0 Reserved 1 0 0 1 Reserved 0 1 0 4 0 1 1 8 Test M8 DLL Reset 0 No 1 0 0 Reserved 1 Yes 1 0 1 Reserved 1 1 0 Reserved 1 1 1 Reserved M11 M10 M9 WRITE RECOVERY M16 M15 M14 0 0 0 1 DLL TM CAS# Latency BT Burst Length M12 PD mode 0 Fast Exit (Normal) 1 7 Address Bus 0 0 0 Reserved 0 0 1 2 M3 0 1 0 3 0 Sequential 0 1 1 4 1 Interleaved 1 0 0 5 1 0 1 6 1 1 0 Reserved 1 1 1 Reserved M6 M5 M4 Mode Register Definition Mode Register (MR) 0 0 1 Extended Mode Register (EMR) 0 1 0 Extended Mode Register (EMR2) 0 1 1 Extended Mode Register (EMR3) Burst Type CAS Latency (CL) 0 0 0 Reserved 0 0 1 Reserved 0 1 0 Reserved 0 1 1 3 1 0 0 4 1 0 1 5 1 1 0 6 1 1 1 Reserved 1. M13 (A13) is reserved for future use and must be programmed to “0.” A13 is not used in x16 configuration. 2. Not all listed CL options are supported in any individual speed grade. Burst Type Accesses within a given burst may be programmed to be either sequential or interleaved. The burst type is selected via bit M3, as shown in Figure 11. The ordering of accesses within a burst is determined by the burst length, the burst type, and the starting column address, as shown in Table 5 on page 26. DDR2 SDRAM supports 4-bit burst mode and 8bit burst mode only. For 8-bit burst mode, full, interleaved address ordering is supported; however, sequential address ordering is nibble-based. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 25 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Mode Register (MR) Table 5: Burst Definition Starting Column Address Burst Length (A2, A1, A0) 4 8 00 01 10 11 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 Order of Accesses Within a Burst Burst Type = Sequential Burst Type = Interleaved 0, 1, 2, 3 1, 2, 3, 0 2, 3, 0, 1 3, 0, 1, 2 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7 1, 2, 3, 0, 5, 6, 7, 4 2, 3, 0, 1, 6, 7, 4, 5 3, 0, 1, 2, 7, 4, 5, 6 4, 5, 6, 7, 0, 1, 2, 3 5, 6, 7, 4, 1, 2, 3, 0 6, 7, 4, 5, 2, 3, 0, 1 7, 4, 5, 6, 3, 0, 1, 2 0, 1, 2, 3 1, 0, 3, 2 2, 3, 0, 1 3, 2, 1, 0 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7 1, 0, 3, 2, 5, 4, 7, 6 2, 3, 0, 1, 6, 7, 4, 5 3, 2, 1, 0, 7, 6, 5, 4 4, 5, 6, 7, 0, 1, 2, 3 5, 4, 7, 6, 1, 0, 3, 2 6, 7, 4, 5, 2, 3, 0, 1 7, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1, 0 Operating Mode The normal operating mode is selected by issuing a command with bit M7 set to “0,” and all other bits set to the desired values, as shown in Figure 11 on page 25. When bit M7 is “1,” no other bits of the mode register are programmed. Programming bit M7 to “1” places the DDR2 SDRAM into a test mode that is only used by the manufacturer and should not be used. No operation or functionality is guaranteed if M7 bit is “1.” DLL RESET DLL RESET is defined by bit M8, as shown in Figure 11 on page 25. Programming bit M8 to “1” will activate the DLL RESET function. Bit M8 is self-clearing, meaning it returns back to a value of “0” after the DLL RESET function has been issued. Anytime the DLL RESET function is used, 200 clock cycles must occur before a READ command can be issued to allow time for the internal clock to be synchronized with the external clock. Failing to wait for synchronization to occur may result in a violation of the tAC or tDQSCK parameters. Write Recovery Write recovery (WR) time is defined by bits M9–M11, as shown in Figure 11 on page 25. The WR register is used by the DDR2 SDRAM during WRITE with auto precharge operation. During WRITE with auto precharge operation, the DDR2 SDRAM delays the internal auto precharge operation by WR clocks (programmed in bits M9–M11) from the last data burst. An example of WRITE with auto precharge is shown in Figure 43 on page 62. WR values of 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6 clocks may be used for programming bits M9–M11. The user is required to program the value of WR, which is calculated by dividing tWR (in nanoseconds) by tCK (in nanoseconds) and rounding up a noninteger value to the next integer; WR [cycles] = tWR [ns] / tCK [ns]. Reserved states should not be used as unknown operation or incompatibility with future versions may result. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 26 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Mode Register (MR) Power-Down Mode Active power-down (PD) mode is defined by bit M12, as shown in Figure 11 on page 25. PD mode allows the user to determine the active power-down mode, which determines performance versus power savings. PD mode bit M12 does not apply to precharge PD mode. When bit M12 = 0, standard active PD mode, or “fast-exit” active PD mode, is enabled. The tXARD parameter is used for fast-exit active PD exit timing. The DLL is expected to be enabled and running during this mode. When bit M12 = 1, a lower-power active PD mode, or “slow-exit” active PD mode, is enabled. The tXARDS parameter is used for slow-exit active PD exit timing. The DLL can be enabled but “frozen” during active PD mode since the exit-to-READ command timing is relaxed. The power difference expected between IDD3P normal and IDD3P low-power mode is defined in Table 45 on page 118. CAS Latency (CL) The CAS latency (CL) is defined by bits M4–M6, as shown in Figure 11 on page 25. CL is the delay, in clock cycles, between the registration of a READ command and the availability of the first bit of output data. The CL can be set to 3, 4, 5, or 6 clocks, depending on the speed grade option being used. DDR2 SDRAM does not support any half-clock latencies. Reserved states should not be used as unknown operation or incompatibility with future versions may result. DDR2 SDRAM also supports a feature called posted CAS additive latency (AL). This feature allows the READ command to be issued prior to tRCD (MIN) by delaying the internal command to the DDR2 SDRAM by AL clocks. The AL feature is described in more detail in “Posted CAS Additive Latency (AL)” on page 31. Examples of CL = 3 and CL = 4 are shown in Figure 12 on page 28; both assume AL = 0. If a READ command is registered at clock edge n, and the CL is m clocks, the data will be available nominally coincident with clock edge n + m (this assumes AL = 0). PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 27 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Extended Mode Register (EMR) Figure 12: CK# CAS Latency (CL) T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 READ NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP CK COMMAND DQS, DQS# DOUT n DQ DOUT n+1 DOUT n+2 DOUT n+3 CL = 3 (AL = 0) CK# T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 READ NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP CK COMMAND DQS, DQS# DOUT n DQ DOUT n+1 DOUT n+2 DOUT n+3 CL = 4 (AL = 0) TRANSITIONING DATA Notes: DON’T CARE 1. BL = 4. 2. Posted CAS# additive latency (AL) = 0. 3. Shown with nominal tAC, tDQSCK, and tDQSQ. Extended Mode Register (EMR) The extended mode register controls functions beyond those controlled by the mode register; these additional functions are DLL enable/disable, output drive strength, ondie termination (ODT) (RTT), posted AL, off-chip driver impedance calibration (OCD), DQS# enable/disable, RDQS/RDQS# enable/disable, and output disable/enable. These functions are controlled via the bits shown in Figure 13 on page 29. The EMR is programmed via the LM command and will retain the stored information until it is programmed again or the device loses power. Reprogramming the EMR will not alter the contents of the memory array, provided it is performed correctly. The EMR must be loaded when all banks are idle and no bursts are in progress, and the controller must wait the specified time tMRD before initiating any subsequent operation. Violating either of these requirements could result in unspecified operation. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 28 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM DLL Enable/Disable Figure 13: Extended Mode Register Definition BA2 BA1 BA0 A13 A12 A11 A10 A9 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 16 15 14 13 MRS 12 11 10 9 8 7 0 E12 Outputs 0 Enabled 4 3 2 1 1 Disabled E6 E2 Rtt (nominal) E11 RDQS Enable 0 0 No 1 Yes 0 Enable 1 Disable RTT disabled Address Bus Extended Mode Register (Ex) E0 DLL Enable 0 Enable (Normal) 1 Disable (Test/Debug) 0 0 0 1 75Ω 1 0 150Ω E1 1 1 50Ω 0 Full strength (18Ω target) 1 Reduced strength (40Ω target) E10 DQS# Enable Output Drive Strength E5 E4 E3 Posted CAS# Additive Latency (AL) E9 E8 E7 OCD Operation Notes: 5 out RDQS DQS# OCD Program RTT Posted CAS# RTT ODS DLL 2 E16 E15 E14 6 A1 A0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 2 0 1 1 3 0 0 0 OCD not supported1 1 0 0 4 0 0 1 Reserved 1 0 1 Reserved 0 1 0 Reserved 1 1 0 Reserved 1 0 0 Reserved 1 1 1 Reserved 1 1 1 OCD default state1 Mode Register Set Mode register set (MRS) 0 0 0 0 0 1 Extended mode register (EMRS) 0 1 0 Extended mode register (EMRS2) 0 1 1 Extended mode register (EMRS3) 1. During initialization, all three bits must be set to “1” for OCD default state, then must be set to “0” before initialization is finished, as detailed in the notes on pages 22–23. 2. E13 (A13) is not used on the x16 configuration. DLL Enable/Disable The DLL may be enabled or disabled by programming bit E0 during the LM command, as shown in Figure 13. The DLL must be enabled for normal operation. DLL enable is required during power-up initialization and upon returning to normal operation after having disabled the DLL for the purpose of debugging or evaluation. Enabling the DLL should always be followed by resetting the DLL using the LM command. The DLL is automatically disabled when entering SELF REFRESH operation and is automatically re-enabled and reset upon exit of SELF REFRESH operation. Anytime the DLL is enabled (and subsequently reset), 200 clock cycles must occur before a READ command can be issued, to allow time for the internal clock to synchronize with the external clock. Failing to wait for synchronization to occur may result in a violation of the tAC or tDQSCK parameters. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 29 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Output Drive Strength Output Drive Strength The output drive strength is defined by bit E1, as shown in Figure 13 on page 29. The normal drive strength for all outputs are specified to be SSTL_18. Programming bit E1 = 0 selects normal (full strength) drive strength for all outputs. Selecting a reduced drive strength option (E1 = 1) will reduce all outputs to approximately 60 percent of the SSTL_18 drive strength. This option is intended for the support of lighter load and/or point-to-point environments. DQS# Enable/Disable The DQS# ball is enabled by bit E10. When E10 = 0, DQS# is the complement of the differential data strobe pair DQS/DQS#. When disabled (E10 = 1), DQS is used in a single-ended mode and the DQS# ball is disabled. When disabled, DQS# should be left floating. This function is also used to enable/disable RDQS#. If RDQS is enabled (E11 = 1) and DQS# is enabled (E10 = 0), then both DQS# and RDQS# will be enabled. RDQS Enable/Disable The RDQS ball is enabled by bit E11, as shown in Figure 13 on page 29. This feature is only applicable to the x8 configuration. When enabled (E11 = 1), RDQS is identical in function and timing to data strobe DQS during a READ. During a WRITE operation, RDQS is ignored by the DDR2 SDRAM. Output Enable/Disable The OUTPUT ENABLE function is defined by bit E12, as shown in Figure 13 on page 29. When enabled (E12 = 0), all outputs (DQs, DQS, DQS#, RDQS, RDQS#) function normally. When disabled (E12 = 1), all DDR2 SDRAM outputs (DQs, DQS, DQS#, RDQS, RDQS#) are disabled, thus removing output buffer current. The output disable feature is intended to be used during IDD characterization of read current. On-Die Termination (ODT) ODT effective resistance, RTT (EFF), is defined by bits E2 and E6 of the EMR, as shown in Figure 13 on page 29. The ODT feature is designed to improve signal integrity of the memory channel by allowing the DDR2 SDRAM controller to independently turn on/off ODT for any or all devices. RTT effective resistance values of 50Ω, 75Ω, and 150Ω are selectable and apply to each DQ, DQS/DQS#, RDQS/RDQS#, UDQS/UDQS#, LDQS/ LDQS#, DM, and UDM/LDM signals. Bits (E6, E2) determine what ODT resistance is enabled by turning on/off “sw1,” “sw2,” or “sw3.” The ODT effective resistance value is selected by enabling switch “sw1,” which enables all R1 values that are 150Ω each, enabling an effective resistance of 75Ω (RTT2 (EFF) = R2/2). Similarly, if “sw2” is enabled, all R2 values that are 300Ω each, enable an effective ODT resistance of 150Ω (RTT2 (EFF) = R2/2). Switch “sw3” enables R1 values of 100Ω, enabling effective resistance of 50Ω. Reserved states should not be used, as unknown operation or incompatibility with future versions may result. The ODT control ball is used to determine when RTT (EFF) is turned on and off, assuming ODT has been enabled via bits E2 and E6 of the EMR. The ODT feature and ODT input ball are only used during active, active power-down (both fast-exit and slowexit modes), and precharge power-down modes of operation. ODT must be turned off prior to entering self refresh. During power-up and initialization of the DDR2 SDRAM, ODT should be disabled until issuing the EMR command to enable the ODT feature, at PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 30 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Off-Chip Driver (OCD) Impedance Calibration which point the ODT ball will determine the RTT (EFF) value. Any time the EMR enables the ODT function, ODT may not be driven HIGH until eight clocks after the EMR has been enabled. See “ODT Timing” on page 79 for ODT timing diagrams. Off-Chip Driver (OCD) Impedance Calibration The OFF-CHIP DRIVER function is no longer supported and must be set to the default state. See “Initialization” on page 21 for proper setting of OCD defaults. Posted CAS Additive Latency (AL) Posted CAS additive latency (AL) is supported to make the command and data bus efficient for sustainable bandwidths in DDR2 SDRAM. Bits E3–E5 define the value of AL, as shown in Figure 13 on page 29. Bits E3–E5 allow the user to program the DDR2 SDRAM with an inverse AL of 0, 1, 2, 3, or 4 clocks. Reserved states should not be used as unknown operation or incompatibility with future versions may result. In this operation, the DDR2 SDRAM allows a READ or WRITE command to be issued prior to tRCD (MIN) with the requirement that AL ≤ tRCD (MIN). A typical application using this feature would set AL = tRCD (MIN) - 1 x tCK. The READ or WRITE command is held for the time of the AL before it is issued internally to the DDR2 SDRAM device. RL is controlled by the sum of AL and CL; RL = AL + CL. Write latency (WL) is equal to RL minus one clock; WL = AL + CL - 1 x tCK. An example of RL is shown in Figure 14. An example of a WL is shown in Figure 15 on page 32. Figure 14: CK# READ Latency T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 T7 T8 ACTIVE n READ n NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP CK COMMAND DQS, DQS# tRCD (MIN) DQ AL = 2 CL = 3 DOUT n DOUT n+1 DOUT n+2 DOUT n+3 RL = 5 TRANSITIONING DATA Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. DON’T CARE BL = 4. Shown with nominal tAC, tDQSCK, and tDQSQ. CL = 3. AL = 2. RL = AL +CL = 5. 31 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Extended Mode Register 2 Figure 15: WRITE Latency T0 T1 ACTIVE n WRITE n T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 T7 NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP CK# CK COMMAND t RCD (MIN) DQS, DQS# AL = 2 CL - 1 = 2 DIN n DQ DIN n+1 DIN n+2 DIN n+3 WL = AL + CL - 1 = 4 TRANSITIONING DATA Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. DON’T CARE BL = 4. CL = 3. AL = 2. WL = AL + CL - 1 = 4. Extended Mode Register 2 The extended mode register 2 (EMR2) controls functions beyond those controlled by the mode register. Currently all bits in EMR2 are reserved, except for E7, which is for commercial or high-temperature operations, as shown in Figure 16. The EMR2 is programmed via the LM command and will retain the stored information until it is programmed again or the device loses power. Reprogramming the EMR will not alter the contents of the memory array, provided it is performed correctly. Bit E7 (A7) must be programmed as “1” to provide a faster refresh rate on IT devices if the TCASE exceeds 85°C. EMR2 must be loaded when all banks are idle and no bursts are in progress, and the controller must wait the specified time tMRD before initiating any subsequent operation. Violating either of these requirements could result in unspecified operation. Figure 16: Extended Mode Register 2 (EMR2) Definition BA2 BA1 BA0 A13 A12 A11 A10 A9 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 EMR2 01 01 01 01 01 01 01 01 01 01 01 01 M16 M15 M14 Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Mode Register Definition A1 A0 1 1 0 0 01 Address Bus Extended Mode Register (Ex) E7 High Temperature Self Refresh rate enable 0 0 0 Mode register (MR) 0 0 1 Extended mode register (EMR) 0 1 0 Extended mode register (EMR2) 0 1 1 Extended mode register (EMR3) 0 1 Commercial temperature default Industrial temperature option; use if TC exceeds 85°C 1. E13 (A13)–E8 (A8) and E6 (A6)–E0 (A0) are reserved for future use and must all be programmed to “0.” A13 is not used in x16 configuration. 32 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Extended Mode Register 3 Extended Mode Register 3 The extended mode register 3 (EMR3) controls functions beyond those controlled by the mode register. Currently all bits in EMR3 are reserved, as shown in Figure 17 on page 33. The EMR3 is programmed via the LM command and will retain the stored information until it is programmed again or the device loses power. Reprogramming the EMR will not alter the contents of the memory array, provided it is performed correctly. EMR3 must be loaded when all banks are idle and no bursts are in progress, and the controller must wait the specified time tMRD before initiating any subsequent operation. Violating either of these requirements could result in unspecified operation. Figure 17: Extended Mode Register 3 (EMR3) Definition BA2 BA1 BA0 A13 A12 A11 A10 A9 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 EMR3 01 01 01 01 01 01 01 01 01 01 01 M16 M15 M14 Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 2 01 A1 A0 1 01 0 01 Address Bus Extended Mode Register (Ex) Mode Register Definition 0 0 0 Mode register (MR) 0 0 1 Extended mode register (EMR) 0 1 0 Extended mode register (EMR2) 0 1 1 Extended mode register (EMR3) 1. E13 (A13)–E0 (A0) are reserved for future use and must all be programmed to “0.” A13 is not used in x16 configuration. 33 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Command Truth Tables Command Truth Tables The following tables provide a quick reference of DDR2 SDRAM available commands, including CKE power-down modes and bank-to-bank commands. Table 6: Truth Table – DDR2 Commands Notes: 1, 5, and 6 apply to all CKE Function BA2 BA1 BA0 A13, A12, A11 L H H X H BA X X H L L H H Previous Cycle Current Cycle CS# A10 A9–A0 LOAD MODE REFRESH SELF REFRESH entry H H H H H L SELF REFRESH exit L H L L L H L L L L X H L L L X H X X OP Code X X X X X X X X 7 H H L L L BA X L X 2 H H L H L X X H X H H L H H BA WRITE H L H L L BA WRITE with auto precharge H L H L L BA READ H H L H L H BA H H L H L H BA H H X X H L Power-down exit L H H X X H X H H X X H X H H X X H X H X X Power-down entry L H H L H L Single bank PRECHARGE All banks PRECHARGE Bank activate READ with auto precharge NO OPERATION Device DESELECT Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN RAS# CAS# WE# Notes 2 Row Address Column Column L Address Address Column Column H Address Address Column Column L Address Address Column Column H Address Address X X X X X X 2, 3 2, 3 2, 3 2, 3 X X X X 4 X X X X 4 1. All DDR2 SDRAM commands are defined by states of CS#, RAS#, CAS#, WE#, and CKE at the rising edge of the clock. 2. Bank addresses (BA) BA0–BA2 determine which bank is to be operated upon. BA during a LM command selects which mode register is programmed. 3. Burst reads or writes at BL = 4 cannot be terminated or interrupted. See Figure 25 on page 45 and Figure 39 on page 58 for other restrictions and details. 4. The power-down mode does not perform any REFRESH operations. The duration of powerdown is limited by the refresh requirements outlined in the AC parametric section. 5. The state of ODT does not affect the states described in this table. The ODT function is not available during self refresh. See “ODT Timing” on page 79 for details. 6. “X” means “H or L” (but a defined logic level). 7. SELF REFRESH exit is asynchronous. 34 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Command Truth Tables Table 7: Truth Table – Current State Bank n – Command to Bank n Notes: 1–6; notes appear below and on next page Current State CS# RAS# CAS# WE# Command/Action Notes Any H L X H X H X H Idle L L L L L L L L L L L L L L L H H L H H L H H L H L L L L H L L H L L H H H L H L L H L L H L L DESELECT (NOP/continue previous operation) NO OPERATION (NOP/continue previous operation) ACTIVE (select and activate row) REFRESH LOAD MODE READ (select column and start READ burst) WRITE (select column and start WRITE burst) PRECHARGE (deactivate row in bank or banks) READ (select column and start new READ burst) WRITE (select column and start WRITE burst) PRECHARGE (start PRECHARGE) READ (select column and start READ burst) WRITE (select column and start new WRITE burst) PRECHARGE (start PRECHARGE) 7 7 9 9 8 9 9, 10 8 9 9 8 Row active Read (autoprecharge Disabled Write (autoprecharge disabled) Notes: 1. This table applies when CKEn - 1 was HIGH and CKEn is HIGH and after tXSNR has been met (if the previous state was self refresh). 2. This table is bank-specific, except where noted (the current state is for a specific bank and the commands shown are those allowed to be issued to that bank when in that state). Exceptions are covered in the notes below. 3. Current state definitions: The bank has been precharged, tRP has been met, and any READ burst is complete. Row active: A row in the bank has been activated, and tRCD has been met. No data bursts/ accesses and no register accesses are in progress. Read: A READ burst has been initiated, with auto precharge disabled, and has not yet terminated. Write: A WRITE burst has been initiated, with auto precharge disabled, and has not yet terminated. 4. The following states must not be interrupted by a command issued to the same bank. Issue DESELECT or NOP commands, or allowable commands to the other bank, on any clock edge occurring during these states. Allowable commands to the other bank are determined by its current state and this table, and according to Table 8 on page 37. Idle: Starts with registration of a PRECHARGE command and ends when tRP is met. Once tRP is met, the bank will be in the idle state. Read with auto Starts with registration of a READ command with auto precharge precharge enabled: enabled and ends when tRP has been met. Once tRP is met, the bank will be in the idle state. Row activating: Starts with registration of an ACTIVE command and ends when tRCD is met. Once tRCD is met, the bank will be in the “row active” state. Write with auto Starts with registration of a WRITE command with auto precharge precharge enabled: enabled and ends when tRP has been met. Once tRP is met, the bank will be in the idle state. Precharging: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 35 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Command Truth Tables 5. The following states must not be interrupted by any executable command (DESELECT or NOP commands must be applied on each positive clock edge during these states): Starts with registration of a REFRESH command and ends when tRFC is met. Once tRFC is met, the DDR2 SDRAM will be in the all banks idle state. Accessing mode Starts with registration of the LM command and ends when tMRD has register: been met. Once tMRD is met, the DDR2 SDRAM will be in the all banks idle state. Precharging all: Starts with registration of a PRECHARGE ALL command and ends when t RP is met. Once tRP is met, all banks will be in the idle state. Refreshing: 6. All states and sequences not shown are illegal or reserved. 7. Not bank-specific; requires that all banks are idle and bursts are not in progress. 8. May or may not be bank-specific; if multiple banks are to be precharged, each must be in a valid state for precharging. 9. READs or WRITEs listed in the Command/Action column include READs or WRITEs with auto precharge enabled and READs or WRITEs with auto precharge disabled. 10. A WRITE command may be applied after the completion of the READ burst. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 36 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Command Truth Tables Table 8: Truth Table – Current State Bank n – Command to Bank m Notes: 1–6; notes appear below and on next page Current State Any Idle Row Activating, Active, or Precharging Read (auto precharge disabled Write (auto precharge disabled.) Read (with autoprecharge) Write (with autoprecharge) CS# RAS# CAS# WE# H L X L L L L L L L L L L L L L L L L L L L L X H X L H H L L H H L L H H L L H H L L H H L X H X H L L H H L L H H L L H H L L H H L L H X H X H H L L H H L L H H L L H H L L H H L L Notes: Command/Action DESELECT (NOP/continue previous operation) NO OPERATION (NOP/continue previous operation) Any command otherwise allowed to bank m ACTIVE (select and activate row) READ (select column and start READ burst) WRITE (select column and start WRITE burst) PRECHARGE ACTIVE (select and activate row) READ (select column and start new READ burst) WRITE (select column and start WRITE burst) PRECHARGE ACTIVE (select and activate row) READ (select column and start READ burst) WRITE (select column and start new WRITE burst) PRECHARGE ACTIVE (select and activate row) READ (select column and start new READ burst) WRITE (select column and start WRITE burst) PRECHARGE ACTIVE (select and activate row) READ (select column and start READ burst) WRITE (select column and start new WRITE burst) PRECHARGE Notes 7 7 7 7, 9 7, 8 7 7, 3 7, 9, 3 7, 3 7, 3 1. This table applies when CKEn - 1 was HIGH and CKEn is HIGH and after tXSNR has been met (if the previous state was self refresh). 2. This table describes alternate bank operation, except where noted (i.e., the current state is for bank n and the commands shown are those allowed to be issued to bank m, assuming that bank m is in such a state that the given command is allowable). Exceptions are covered in the notes below. 3. Current state definitions: The bank has been precharged, tRP has been met, and any READ burst is complete. Row active: A row in the bank has been activated and tRCD has been met. No data bursts/ accesses and no register accesses are in progress. Read: A READ burst has been initiated with auto precharge disabled, and has not yet terminated. Write: A WRITE burst has been initiated, with auto precharge disabled, and has not yet terminated. Idle: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 37 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Command Truth Tables READ with auto precharge enabled/ WRITE with auto precharge enabled: The READ with auto precharge enabled or WRITE with auto precharge enabled states can each be broken into two parts: the access period and the precharge period. For READ with auto precharge, the precharge period is defined as if the same burst was executed with auto precharge disabled and then followed with the earliest possible PRECHARGE command that still accesses all of the data in the burst. For WRITE with auto precharge, the precharge period begins when tWR ends, with tWR measured as if auto precharge was disabled. The access period starts with registration of the command and ends where the precharge period (or tRP) begins. This device supports concurrent auto precharge such that when a READ with auto precharge is enabled or a WRITE with auto precharge is enabled, any command to other banks is allowed, as long as that command does not interrupt the read or write data transfer already in process. In either case, all other related limitations apply (contention between read data and write data must be avoided). The minimum delay from a READ or WRITE command with auto precharge enabled to a command to a different bank is summarized in Table 9: Table 9: Minimum Delay with Auto Precharge Enabled From Command (Bank n) To Command (Bank m) WRITE with auto precharge READ or READ with auto precharge WRITE or WRITE with auto precharge PRECHARGE or ACTIVE READ or READ with auto precharge WRITE or WRITE with auto precharge PRECHARGE or ACTIVE READ with auto precharge Minimum Delay (with concurrent auto precharge) Units (CL - 1) + (BL / 2) + tWTR tCK (BL / 2) tCK 1 (BL / 2) tCK (BL / 2) + 2 tCK 1 tCK tCK 4. 5. 6. 7. REFRESH and LM commands may only be issued when all banks are idle. Not used. All states and sequences not shown are illegal or reserved. READs or WRITEs listed in the Command/Action column include READs or WRITEs with auto precharge enabled and READs or WRITEs with auto precharge disabled. 8. Requires appropriate DM. 9. A WRITE command may be applied after the completion of the READ burst. 10. The number of clock cycles required to meet tWTR is either 2 or tWTR/tCK, whichever is greater. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 38 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM DESELECT, NOP, and LM Commands DESELECT, NOP, and LM Commands DESELECT The DESELECT function (CS# HIGH) prevents new commands from being executed by the DDR2 SDRAM. The DDR2 SDRAM is effectively deselected. Operations already in progress are not affected. DESELECT is also referred to as COMMAND INHIBIT. NO OPERATION (NOP) The NO OPERATION (NOP) command is used to instruct the selected DDR2 SDRAM to perform a NOP (CS# is LOW; RAS#, CAS#, and WE are HIGH). This prevents unwanted commands from being registered during idle or wait states. Operations already in progress are not affected. LOAD MODE (LM) The mode registers are loaded via inputs BA2–BA0 and A13–A0 for x4 and x8, and A12–A0 for x16 configurations. BA2–BA0 determine which mode register will be programmed. See “Mode Register (MR)” on page 24. The LM command can only be issued when all banks are idle, and a subsequent executable command cannot be issued until tMRD is met. Bank/Row Activation ACTIVE Command The ACTIVE command is used to open (or activate) a row in a particular bank for a subsequent access. The value on the BA2–BA0 inputs selects the bank, and the address provided on inputs (A13–A0 for x4 and x8, and A12–A0 for x16) selects the row. This row remains active (or open) for accesses until a PRECHARGE command is issued to that bank. A PRECHARGE command must be issued before opening a different row in the same bank. ACTIVE Operation Before any READ or WRITE commands can be issued to a bank within the DDR2 SDRAM, a row in that bank must be opened (activated), even when additive latency is used. This is accomplished via the ACTIVE command, which selects both the bank and the row to be activated, as shown in Figure 18 on page 40. After a row is opened with an ACTIVE command, a READ or WRITE command may be issued to that row subject to the tRCD specification. tRCD (MIN) should be divided by the clock period and rounded up to the next whole number to determine the earliest clock edge after the ACTIVE command on which a READ or WRITE command can be entered. The same procedure is used to convert other specification limits from time units to clock cycles. For example, a tRCD (MIN) specification of 20ns with a 266 MHz clock (tCK = 3.75ns) results in 5.3 clocks, rounded up to 6. This is reflected in Figure 21 on page 42, which covers any case where 5 < tRCD (MIN) / tCK ≤ 6. Figure 21 also shows the case for tRRD where 2 < tRRD (MIN) / tCK ≤ 3. A subsequent ACTIVE command to a different row in the same bank can only be issued after the previous active row has been closed (precharged). The minimum time interval between successive ACTIVE commands to the same bank is defined by tRC. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 39 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Bank/Row Activation A subsequent ACTIVE command to another bank can be issued while the first bank is being accessed, which results in a reduction of total row-access overhead. The minimum time interval between successive ACTIVE commands to different banks is defined by t RRD. Figure 18: ACTIVE Command CK# CK CKE CS# RAS# CAS# WE# ADDRESS Row BANK ADDRESS Bank DON’T CARE DDR2 SDRAM also supports the AL feature, which allows a READ or WRITE command to be issued prior to tRCD (MIN) by delaying the actual registration of the READ/WRITE command to the internal device by AL clock cycles. No more than 4-bank ACTIVE commands may be issued in a given tFAW (MIN) period. RRD (MIN) restriction still applies. The tFAW (MIN) parameters apply to all 8-bank DDR2 devices, regardless of the number of banks already open or closed, as shown in Figure 19 . t Figure 19: 8-Bank Activate Restriction T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 T7 T8 T9 T10 COMMAND ACT READ ACT READ ACT READ ACT READ NOP NOP ACT ADDRESS Row Col Row Col Row Col Row Col Row Bank a Bank b Bank b Bank c Bank c Bank d Bank d Bank e CK# CK BA0, BA1, BA2 Bank a t RRD (MIN) t FAW (MIN) DON’T CARE Note: 8-bank DDR2-533 (-37E, x4 or x8), tCK = 3.75ns, BL = 4, AL = 3, CL = 4, tRRD (MIN) = 7.5ns, FAW (MIN) = 37.5ns. t PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 40 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM READ Command READ Command The READ command is used to initiate a burst read access to an active row. The value on the BA2–BA0 inputs selects the bank, and the address provided on inputs A0–i (where i = A9 for x16, A9 for x8, or A9, A11 for x4) selects the starting column location. The value on input A10 determines whether or not auto precharge is used. If auto precharge is selected, the row being accessed will be precharged at the end of the READ burst; if auto precharge is not selected, the row will remain open for subsequent accesses. READ Operation READ bursts are initiated with a READ command, as shown in Figure 20 on page 42. The starting column and bank addresses are provided with the READ command and auto precharge is either enabled or disabled for that burst access. If auto precharge is enabled, the row being accessed is automatically precharged at the completion of the burst. If auto precharge is disabled, the row will be left open after the completion of the burst. During READ bursts, the valid data-out element from the starting column address will be available READ latency (RL) clocks later. RL is defined as the sum of AL and CL; RL = AL + CL. The value for AL and CL are programmable via the MR and EMR commands, respectively. Each subsequent data-out element will be valid nominally at the next positive or negative clock edge (i.e., at the next crossing of CK and CK#). Figure 22 on page 43 shows examples of RL based on different AL and CL settings. DQS/DQS# is driven by the DDR2 SDRAM along with output data. The initial LOW state on DQS and HIGH state on DQS# is known as the read preamble (tRPRE). The LOW state on DQS and HIGH state on DQS# coincident with the last data-out element is known as the read postamble (tRPST). Upon completion of a burst, assuming no other commands have been initiated, the DQ will go High-Z. A detailed explanation of tDQSQ (valid data-out skew), tQH (data-out window hold), and the valid data window are depicted in Figure 31 on page 51 and Figure 32 on page 52. A detailed explanation of tDQSCK (DQS transition skew to CK) and t AC (data-out transition skew to CK) is shown in Figure 33 on page 53. Data from any READ burst may be concatenated with data from a subsequent READ command to provide a continuous flow of data. The first data element from the new burst follows the last element of a completed burst. The new READ command should be issued x cycles after the first READ command, where x equals BL / 2 cycles. This is shown in Figure 23 on page 44. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 41 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM READ Command Figure 20: READ Command CK# CK CKE CS# RAS# CAS# WE# ADDRESS Col ENABLE AUTO PRECHARGE A10 DISABLE BANK ADDRESS Bank DON’T CARE Figure 21: CK# Example: Meeting tRRD (MIN) and tRCD (MIN) T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 T7 T8 T9 ACT NOP NOP ACT NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP RD/WR CK COMMAND ADDRESS BA0, BA1, BA2 Row Row Bank x Col Bank y Bank y tRRD tRCD DON’T CARE PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 42 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM READ Command Figure 22: READ Latency T0 T1 T2 T3 T3n READ NOP NOP NOP T4 T4n T5 CK# CK COMMAND ADDRESS NOP NOP Bank a, Col n RL = 3 (AL = 0, CL = 3) DQS, DQS# DO n DQ T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T4n READ NOP NOP NOP NOP T5 T5n CK# CK COMMAND ADDRESS NOP Bank a, Col n CL = 3 AL = 1 RL = 4 (AL = 1 + CL = 3) DQS, DQS# DO n DQ T0 T1 T2 T3 READ NOP NOP NOP T3n T4 T4n T5 CK# CK COMMAND ADDRESS NOP NOP Bank a, Col n RL = 4 (AL = 0, CL = 4) DQS, DQS# DQ DO n DON’T CARE Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 1. 2. 3. 4. TRANSITIONING DATA DO n = data-out from column n. BL = 4. Three subsequent elements of data-out appear in the programmed order following DO n. Shown with nominal tAC, tDQSCK, and tDQSQ. 43 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM READ Command Figure 23: Consecutive READ Bursts T0 T1 T2 T3 COMMAND READ NOP READ NOP ADDRESS Bank, Col n T3n T4 T4n T5n T5 T6n T6 CK# CK NOP NOP NOP Bank, Col b t CCD RL = 3 DQS, DQS# DO n DQ T0 T1 T2 COMMAND READ NOP READ ADDRESS Bank, Col n T2n T3 CK# DO b T3n T4 T4n T5 T5n T6n T6 CK NOP NOP NOP NOP Bank, Col b t CCD RL = 4 DQS, DQS# DO n DQ DON’T CARE Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. DO b TRANSITIONING DATA DO n (or b) = data-out from column n (or column b). BL = 4. Three subsequent elements of data-out appear in the programmed order following DO n. Three subsequent elements of data-out appear in the programmed order following DO b. Shown with nominal tAC, tDQSCK, and tDQSQ. Example applies only when READ commands are issued to same device. Nonconsecutive read data is illustrated in Figure 24 on page 45. Full-speed random read accesses within a page (or pages) can be performed. DDR2 SDRAM supports the use of concurrent auto precharge timing, shown in Table 10 on page 46. DDR2 SDRAM does not allow interrupting or truncating of any READ burst using BL = 4 operations. Once the BL = 4 READ command is registered, it must be allowed to complete the entire READ burst. However, a READ (with auto precharge disabled) using BL = 8 operation may be interrupted and truncated only by another READ burst as long as the interruption occurs on a 4-bit boundary due to the 4n prefetch architecture of DDR2 SDRAM. READ burst BL = 8 operations may not be interrupted or truncated with any command except another READ command, as shown in Figure 25 on page 45. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 44 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM READ Command Figure 24: Nonconsecutive READ Bursts T0 T1 T2 T3 COMMAND READ NOP NOP READ ADDRESS Bank, Col n CK# T3n T4 T4n T5 T6 T6n NOP NOP T7 T7n T8 CK NOP NOP NOP Bank, Col b CL = 3 DQS, DQS# DO n DQ DO b T4n T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 COMMAND READ NOP NOP READ NOP ADDRESS Bank, Col n CK# T5 T5n T6 T7 T7n NOP NOP T8 CK NOP NOP Bank, Col b CL = 4 DQS, DQS# DO n DQ DON’T CARE Notes: Figure 25: CK# T0 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. DO b TRANSITIONING DATA DO n (or b) = data-out from column n (or column b). BL = 4. Three subsequent elements of data-out appear in the programmed order following DO n. Three subsequent elements of data-out appear in the programmed order following DO b. Shown with nominal tAC, tDQSCK, and tDQSQ. Example applies when READ commands are issued to different devices or nonconsecutive READs. READ Interrupted by READ T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 T7 T8 T9 READ3 NOP5 VALID VALID VALID VALID VALID VALID CK COMMAND READ1 ADDRESS VALID2 NOP5 VALID2 VALID4 A10 DQS, DQS# DQ CL = 3 (AL = 0) tCCD DOUT DOUT DOUT DOUT DOUT DOUT DOUT DOUT DOUT DOUT DOUT CL = 3 (AL = 0) TRANSITIONING DATA Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN DOUT DON’T CARE 1. BL = 8 required; auto precharge must be disabled (A10 = LOW). 2. READ command can be issued to any valid bank and row address (READ command at T0 and T2 can be either same bank or different bank). 3. Interrupting READ command must be issued exactly 2 x tCK from previous READ. 4. Auto precharge can be either enabled (A10 = HIGH) or disabled (A10 = LOW) by the interrupting READ command. 5. NOP or COMMAND INHIBIT commands are valid. PRECHARGE command cannot be issued to banks used for READs at T0 and T2. 6. Example shown uses AL = 0; CL = 3, BL = 8, shown with nominal tAC, tDQSCK, and tDQSQ. 45 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM READ Command Table 10: READ Using Concurrent Auto Precharge From Command (Bank n) To Command (Bank m) Minimum Delay (with Concurrent Auto Precharge) READ with auto precharge READ or READ with auto precharge WRITE or WRITE with auto precharge PRECHARGE or ACTIVE BL/2 (BL/2) + 2 1 Units t CK CK t CK t Data from any READ burst must be completed before a subsequent WRITE burst is allowed. An example of a READ burst followed by a WRITE burst is shown in Figure 28 on page 48. The tDQSS (MIN) case is shown; the tDQSS (MAX) case has a longer bus idle time. (tDQSS [MIN] and tDQSS [MAX] are defined in Figure 35 on page 56.) A READ burst may be followed by a PRECHARGE command to the same bank, provided that auto precharge was not activated. The minimum READ-to-PRECHARGE command spacing to the same bank is AL + BL/2 clocks and must also satisfy a minimum analog time from the rising clock edge that initiates the last 4-bit prefetch of a READ-toPRECHARGE command. This READ-to-PRECHARGE time is called tRTP. For BL = 4 this is the time from the actual READ (AL after the READ command) to PRECHARGE command. For BL = 8 this is the time from AL + 2CK after the READ-to-PRECHARGE command. Following the PRECHARGE command, a subsequent command to the same bank cannot be issued until tRP is met. Note: Part of the row precharge time is hidden during the access of the last data elements. Examples of READ-to-PRECHARGE are shown in Figure 26 on page 47 for BL = 4 and Figure 27 on page 47 for BL = 8. The delay from READ-to-PRECHARGE command to the same bank is AL + BL/2 + MAX (tRTP/tCK or 2CK) - 2CK. If A10 is HIGH when a READ command is issued, the READ with auto precharge function is engaged. The DDR2 SDRAM starts an auto precharge operation on the rising edge, which is AL + (BL/2) cycles later than the READ with auto precharge command if tRAS (MIN) and tRTP are satisfied. If tRAS (MIN) is not satisfied at the edge, the start point of auto precharge operation will be delayed until tRAS (MIN) is satisfied. If tRTP (MIN) is not satisfied at the edge, the start point of the auto precharge operation will be delayed until tRTP (MIN) is satisfied. In case the internal precharge is pushed out by tRTP, tRP starts at the point where the internal precharge happens (not at the next rising clock edge after this event). For BL = 4, the minimum time from READ with auto precharge to the next ACTIVATE command becomes AL + (tRTP + tRP)*, shown in Figure 26 on page 47; for BL = 8, the time from READ with auto precharge to the next ACTIVATE command is AL + 2 clocks + (tRTP + tRP)*, shown in Figure 27 on page 47. The * indicates each parameter term is divided by tCK and rounded up to the next integer. In any event, internal precharge does not start earlier than two clocks after the last 4-bit prefetch. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 46 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM READ Command Figure 26: READ-to-PRECHARGE – BL = 4 CK# 4-bit prefetch T1 T0 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 T7 NOP PRECHG NOP NOP ACTIVE NOP CK COMMAND NOP READ AL + BL/2 + MAX(tRTP/tCK or 2CK) - 2CK ADDRESS Bank a A10 Bank a Bank a Valid Valid CL = 3 AL = 1 DQS, DQS# ≥tRTP (MIN) DQ DOUT ≥tRAS (MIN) DOUT DOUT DOUT ≥tRP (MIN) ≥tRC (MIN) TRANSITIONING DATA Notes: Figure 27: 1. 2. 3. DON’T CARE RL = 4 (AL = 1, CL = 3); BL = 4. ≥ 2 clocks. Shown with nominal tAC, tDQSCK, and tDQSQ. tRTP READ-to-PRECHARGE – BL = 8 CK# CK COMMAND first 4-bit prefetch T1 T0 READ NOP second 4-bit prefetch T3 T2 NOP NOP T4 T5 T6 T7 T8 NOP PRECHG NOP NOP ACTIVE AL + BL/2 + MAX(tRTP/tCK or 2CK) -2CK ADDRESS Bank a A10 AL = 1 Bank a Bank a Valid Valid CL = 3 DQS, DQS# DQ DOUT ≥tRTP (MIN) DOUT DOUT DOUT DOUT DOUT DOUT DOUT ≥tRP (MIN) ≥tRAS (MIN) ≥tRC (MIN) TRANSITIONING DATA Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 1. 2. 3. DON’T CARE RL = 4 (AL = 1, CL = 3); BL = 8. ≥ 2 clocks. Shown with nominal tAC, tDQSCK, and tDQSQ. tRTP 47 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM READ Command Figure 28: CK# CK COMMAND READ-to-WRITE T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 T7 T8 T9 T10 T11 ACTIVE n READ n NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP WRITE WRITEn NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP DQS, DQS# tRCD = 3 WL = RL - 1 = 4 DOUT n DQ AL = 2 CL = 3 DOUT n+1 DOUT n+2 DOUT n+3 DIN n DIN n+1 DIN n+2 DIN n+3 RL = 5 TRANSITIONING DATA Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN DON’T CARE 1. BL = 4; CL = 3; AL = 2. 2. Shown with nominal tAC, tDQSCK, and tDQSQ. 48 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM READ Command Figure 29: CK# Bank Read – without Auto Precharge T1 T0 T2 CK tCK tCH T3 T4 NOP6 READ2 T5 T6 T7 T7n T8 T8n tCL CKE COMMAND5 NOP6 ACT NOP6 PRE7 NOP6 NOP6 NOP6 ACT tRTP 8 ADDRESS5 RA Col n A105 RA 3 RA ALL BANKS RA ONE BANK BA0, BA1, BA2 Bank x Bank x4 Bank x tRCD Bank x CL = 3 tRP tRAS7 tRC DM tDQSCK (MIN) Case 1: tAC (MIN) and tDQSCK (MIN) 9 DQS, DQS# tRPST 9 tRPRE tLZ (MIN) DO n DQ1 tLZ (MIN) Case 2: tAC (MAX) and tDQSCK (MAX) 9 tRPRE tHZ (MIN) tAC (MIN) tDQSCK (MAX) tRPST 9 DQS, DQS# tLZ (MAX) DQ1 DO n tLZ (MIN) tAC (MAX) DON’T CARE Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN tHZ (MAX) TRANSITIONING DATA 1. DO n = data-out from column n; subsequent elements are applied in the programmed order. 2. BL = 4 and AL = 0 in the case shown. 3. Disable auto precharge. 4. “Don’t Care” if A10 is HIGH at T5. 5. PRE = PRECHARGE, ACT = ACTIVE, RA = row address, BA = bank address. 6. NOP commands are shown for ease of illustration; other commands may be valid at these times. 7. The PRECHARGE command can only be applied at T6 if tRAS (MIN) is met. 8. READ-to-PRECHARGE = AL + BL/2 + (tRTP - 2 clocks). 9. I/O balls, when entering or exiting HIGH-Z, are not referenced to a specific voltage level, but to when the device begins to drive or no longer drives, respectively. 49 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM READ Command Figure 30: CK# Bank Read – with Auto Precharge T1 T0 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 T7 NOP5 NOP5 T7n T8 T8n CK tCK tCH tCL CKE COMMAND5 NOP5 ACT NOP5 NOP5 NOP5 NOP5 ACT Col n RA ADDRESS READ2,6 RA 3 A10 BA0, BA1, BA2 RA RA Bank x Bank x Bank x tRCD AL = 1 CL = 3 tRTP tRAS tRP tRC DM tDQSCK (MIN) Case 1: tAC (MIN) and tDQSCK (MIN) 7 tRPRE tRPST 7 DQS, DQS# tLZ (MIN) DO n DQ1 tLZ (MIN) Case 2: tAC (MAX) and tDQSCK (MAX) 7 tRPRE tHZ (MIN) tAC (MIN) tDQSCK (MAX) tRPST 7 DQS, DQS# tLZ (MAX) DQ1 DO n 4-bit prefetch t Internal LZ (MAX) precharge tAC (MAX) DON’T CARE Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN tHZ (MAX) TRANSITIONING DATA 1. DO n = data-out from column n; subsequent elements are applied in the programmed order. 2. BL = 4, RL = 4 (AL = 1, CL = 3) in the case shown. 3. Enable auto precharge. 4. ACT = ACTIVE, RA = row address, BA = bank address. 5. NOP commands are shown for ease of illustration; other commands may be valid at these times. 6. The DDR2 SDRAM internally delays auto precharge until both tRAS (MIN) and tRTP (MIN) have been satisfied. 7. I/O balls, when entering or exiting HIGH-Z, are not referenced to a specific voltage level, but to when the device begins to drive or no longer drives, respectively. 50 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM READ Command Figure 31: x4, x8 Data Output Timing – tDQSQ, tQH, and Data Valid Window T1 T2 T2n T3 T3n T4 CK# CK tHP5 tHP5 tHP5 tHP5 tDQSQ3 tDQSQ3 tQH4 tQH4 tHP5 tHP5 tDQSQ3 tDQSQ3 DQS# DQS1 DQ (Last data valid) DQ2 DQ2 DQ2 DQ2 DQ2 DQ2 DQ (First data no longer valid) tQH4 tQH4 DQ (Last data valid) T2 T2n T3 T3n DQ (First data no longer valid) T2 T2n T3 T3n All DQs and DQS, collectively6 T2 T2n T3 T3n Data Valid Window Data Valid Window Data Valid Window Data Valid Window Earliest signal transition Latest signal transition Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 1. DQ transitioning after DQS transition define tDQSQ window. DQS transitions at T2 and at T2n are “early DQS,” at T3 are “nominal DQS,” and at T3n are “late DQS.” 2. DQ0, DQ1, DQ2, DQ3 for x4 or DQ0–DQ7 for x8. 3. tDQSQ is derived at each DQS clock edge, is not cumulative over time, begins with DQS transitions, and ends with the last valid transition of DQ. 4. tQH is derived from tHP: tQH = tHP - tQHS. 5. tHP is the lesser of tCL or tCH clock transitions collectively when a bank is active. 6. The data valid window is derived for each DQS transition and is defined as tQH - tDQSQ. 51 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM READ Command Figure 32: x16 Data Output Timing – tDQSQ, tQH, and Data Valid Window CK# T1 T2 T2n T3 T3n T4 CK tHP5 tHP5 tHP5 tHP5 tDQSQ3 tDQSQ3 tQH4 tQH4 tHP5 tHP5 tDQSQ3 tDQSQ3 LDSQ# LDQS1 Lower Byte DQ (Last data valid)2 DQ2 DQ2 DQ2 DQ2 DQ2 DQ2 DQ (First data no longer valid)2 tQH4 tQH4 DQ (Last data valid)2 T2 T2n T3 T3n DQ (First data no longer valid)2 T2 T2n T3 T3n DQ0–DQ7 and LDQS, collectively6 T2 T2n T3 T3n Data Valid Window Data Valid Window Data Valid Window tDQSQ3 Data Valid Window tDQSQ3 tDQSQ3 tDQSQ3 UDQS# UDQS1 Upper Byte DQ (Last data valid)7 DQ7 DQ7 DQ7 DQ7 DQ7 DQ7 DQ (First data no longer valid)7 tQH4 tQH4 tQH4 DQ (Last data valid)7 T2 T2n DQ (First data no longer valid)7 T2 T2n DQ8–DQ15 and UDQS, collectively6 T2 T2n Data Valid Window Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Data Valid Window tQH4 T3 T3 T3n T3n T3 T3n Data Valid Window Data Valid Window 1. DQ transitioning after DQS transitions define the tDQSQ window. LDQS defines the lower byte, and UDQS defines the upper byte. 2. DQ0, DQ1, DQ2, DQ3, DQ4, DQ5, DQ6, or DQ7. 3. tDQSQ is derived at each DQS clock edge, is not cumulative over time, begins with DQS transitions, and ends with the last valid transition of DQ. 4. tQH is derived from tHP: tQH = tHP - tQHS. 5. tHP is the lesser of tCL or tCH clock transitions collectively when a bank is active. 6. The data valid window is derived for each DQS transition and is tQH - tDQSQ. 7. DQ8, DQ9, DQ10, D11, DQ12, DQ13, DQ14, or DQ15. 52 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM READ Command Figure 33: Data Output Timing – tAC and tDQSCK T07 T1 T2 T3 T3n T4 T4n T5 T5n T6 T6n T7 CK# CK tDQSCK1 (MIN) tLZ (MIN) DQS#/DQS, or LDQS#/LDQS / UDQ#/UDQS2 tHZ (MAX) tDQSCK1 (MAX) tRPST tRPRE DQ (Last data valid) T3 T3n T4 T4n T5 T5n T6 T6n DQ (First data valid) T3 T3n T4 T4n T5 T5n T6 T6n All DQs, collectively3 T3 T3n T4 T4n T5 T5n T6 T6n tLZ (MIN) Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN tAC4 (MIN) tAC4 (MAX) tHZ (MAX) 1. tDQSCK is the DQS output window relative to CK and is the “long-term” component of DQS skew. 2. DQ transitioning after DQS transitions define tDQSQ window. 3. All DQ must transition by tDQSQ after DQS transitions, regardless of tAC. 4. tAC is the DQ output window relative to CK and is the “long term” component of DQ skew. 5. tLZ (MIN) and tAC (MIN) are the first valid signal transitions. 6. tHZ (MAX) and tAC (MAX) are the latest valid signal transitions. 7. READ command with CL = 3, AL = 0 issued at T0. 8. I/O balls, when entering or exiting HIGH-Z, are not referenced to a specific voltage level, but to when the device begins to drive or no longer drives, respectively. 53 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM WRITE Command WRITE Command The WRITE command is used to initiate a burst write access to an active row. The value on the BA2–BA0 inputs selects the bank, and the address provided on inputs A0–i (where i = A9 for x8 and x16; or A9, A11 for x4) selects the starting column location. The value on input A10 determines whether or not auto precharge is used. If auto precharge is selected, the row being accessed will be precharged at the end of the WRITE burst; if auto precharge is not selected, the row will remain open for subsequent accesses. Figure 34: WRITE Command CK# CK CKE HIGH CS# RAS# CAS# WE# ADDRESS CA EN AP A10 DIS AP BANK ADDRESS BA DON’T CARE Note: CA = column address; BA = bank address; EN AP = enable auto precharge; and DIS AP = disable auto precharge. Input data appearing on the DQ is written to the memory array subject to the DM input logic level appearing coincident with the data. If a given DM signal is registered LOW, the corresponding data will be written to memory; if the DM signal is registered HIGH, the corresponding data inputs will be ignored, and a WRITE will not be executed to that byte/column location (Figure 44 on page 63). WRITE Operation WRITE bursts are initiated with a WRITE command, as shown in Figure 34. DDR2 SDRAM uses WL equal to RL minus one clock cycle [WL = RL - 1CK = AL + (CL - 1CK)]. The starting column and bank addresses are provided with the WRITE command, and auto precharge is either enabled or disabled for that access. If auto precharge is enabled, the row being accessed is precharged at the completion of the burst. Note: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN For the generic WRITE commands used in the following illustrations, auto precharge is disabled. 54 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM WRITE Command During WRITE bursts, the first valid data-in element will be registered on the first rising edge of DQS following the WRITE command, and subsequent data elements will be registered on successive edges of DQS. The LOW state on DQS between the WRITE command and the first rising edge is known as the write preamble; the LOW state on DQS following the last data-in element is known as the write postamble. The time between the WRITE command and the first rising DQS edge is WL ±tDQSS. Subsequent DQS positive rising edges are timed, relative to the associated clock edge, as ±tDQSS. tDQSS is specified with a relatively wide range (25 percent of one clock cycle). All of the WRITE diagrams show the nominal case, and where the two extreme cases (tDQSS [MIN] and tDQSS [MAX]) might not be intuitive, they have also been included. Figure 35 on page 56 shows the nominal case and the extremes of tDQSS for BL = 4. Upon completion of a burst, assuming no other commands have been initiated, the DQ will remain High-Z and any additional input data will be ignored. Data for any WRITE burst may be concatenated with a subsequent WRITE command to provide continuous flow of input data. The first data element from the new burst is applied after the last element of a completed burst. The new WRITE command should be issued x cycles after the first WRITE command, where x equals BL/2. Figure 36 on page 57 shows concatenated bursts of BL = 4. An example of nonconsecutive WRITEs is shown in Figure 37 on page 57. Full-speed random write accesses within a page or pages can be performed as shown in Figure 38 on page 58. DDR2 SDRAM supports concurrent auto precharge options, as shown in Table 11. DDR2 SDRAM does not allow interrupting or truncating any WRITE burst using BL = 4 operation. Once the BL = 4 WRITE command is registered, it must be allowed to complete the entire WRITE burst cycle. However, a WRITE BL = 8 operation (with auto precharge disabled) might be interrupted and truncated ONLY by another WRITE burst as long as the interruption occurs on a 4-bit boundary, due to the 4n prefetch architecture of DDR2 SDRAM. WRITE burst BL = 8 operations may not be interrupted or truncated with any command except another WRITE command, as shown in Figure 39 on page 58. Data for any WRITE burst may be followed by a subsequent READ command. To follow a WRITE, tWTR should be met, as shown in Figure 40 on page 59. The number of clock cycles required to meet tWTR is either 2 or tWTR/tCK, whichever is greater. Data for any WRITE burst may be followed by a subsequent PRECHARGE command. tWR must be met, as shown in Figure 41 on page 60. tWR starts at the end of the data burst, regardless of the data mask condition. Table 11: WRITE Using Concurrent Auto Precharge From Command (Bank n) WRITE with auto precharge PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Minimum Delay (with concurrent auto precharge) To Command (Bank m) READ or READ with auto precharge WRITE or WRITE with auto precharge PRECHARGE or ACTIVE 55 (CL - 1) + (BL/2) + tWTR Units tCK (BL/2) tCK 1 tCK Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM WRITE Command Figure 35: WRITE Burst T0 T1 T2 COMMAND WRITE NOP NOP ADDRESS Bank a, Col b T2n T3 T3n T4 CK# CK tDQSS (NOM) NOP WL ± tDQSS NOP 5 DQS, DQS# DI b DQ DM tDQSS (MIN) WL - tDQSS tDQSS 5 DQS, DQS# DI b DQ DM tDQSS (MAX) tDQSS WL + tDQSS 5 DQS, DQS# DI b DQ DM DON’T CARE Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN TRANSITIONING DATA 1. DI b = data-in for column b. 2. Three subsequent elements of data-in are applied in the programmed order following DI b. 3. Shown with BL = 4, AL = 0, CL = 3; thus, WL = 2. 4. A10 is LOW with the WRITE command (auto precharge is disabled). 5. Subsequent rising DQS signals must align to the clock within tDQSS. 56 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM WRITE Command Figure 36: Consecutive WRITE-to-WRITE CK# T0 T1 WRITE NOP T1n T2 T2n T3 T3n T4 T4n T5 T5n T6 CK COMMAND WRITE NOP NOP NOP 6 6 NOP t CCD WL = 2 WL = 2 ADDRESS Bank, Col n Bank, Col b t WL ± tDQSS DQSS (NOM) 6 DQS, DQS# DI b DQ DI n DM DON’T CARE Notes: Figure 37: TRANSITIONING DATA 1. DI b, etc. = data-in for column b, etc. 2. Three subsequent elements of data-in are applied in the programmed order following DI b. 3. Three subsequent elements of data-in are applied in the programmed order following DI n. 4. Shown with BL = 4, AL = 0, CL = 3; thus, WL = 2. 5. Each WRITE command may be to any bank. 6. Subsequent rising DQS signals must align to the clock within tDQSS. Nonconsecutive WRITE-to-WRITE CK# T0 T1 T2 WRITE NOP NOP T2n T3 T3n T4 T4n T5 T5n T6 T6n CK COMMAND WRITE t DQSS (NOM) NOP NOP 6 6 WL = 2 WL = 2 ADDRESS NOP Bank, Col b Bank, Col n WL ± tDQSS 6 DQS, DQS# DI n DI b DQ DM DON’T CARE Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN TRANSITIONING DATA 1. DI b, etc. = data-in for column b, etc. 2. Three subsequent elements of data-in are applied in the programmed order following DI b. 3. Three subsequent elements of data-in are applied in the programmed order following DI n. 4. Shown with BL = 4, AL = 0, CL = 3; thus, WL = 2. 5. Each WRITE command may be to any bank. 6. Subsequent rising DQS signals must align to the clock within tDQSS. 57 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM WRITE Command Figure 38: Random WRITE Cycles CK# T0 T1 T1n WRITE NOP T2 T2n T3 T3n T4 T4n T5 T5n T6 CK COMMAND WRITE NOP NOP NOP 6 6 NOP t CCD WL = 2 WL = 2 ADDRESS Bank, Col n Bank, Col b t WL ± tDQSS DQSS (NOM) 6 DQS, DQS# DI b DQ DI n DM DON’T CARE Notes: Figure 39: CK# CK COMMAND ADDRESS TRANSITIONING DATA 1. DI b, etc. = data-in for column b, etc. 2. Three subsequent elements of data-in are applied in the programmed order following DI b. 3. Three subsequent elements of data-in are applied in the programmed order following DI n. 4. Shown with BL = 4, AL = 0, CL = 3; thus, WL = 2. 5. Each WRITE command may be to any bank. 6. Subsequent rising DQS signals must align to the clock within tDQSS. WRITE Interrupted by WRITE T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 T7 T8 T9 WRITE1 a NOP5 WRITE3 b NOP5 NOP5 NOP5 NOP5 VALID6 VALID6 VALID6 VALID2 VALID2 VALID4 A10 8 8 8 8 8 DQS, DQS# DQ WL = 3 2 clock requirement Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN DIN a DIN a+1 DIN a+2 DIN a+3 DIN b DIN b+1 DIN b+2 DIN b+3 DIN b+4 DIN b+5 DIN b+6 TRANSITIONING DATA WL = 3 DIN b+7 DON’T CARE 1. BL = 8 required and auto precharge must be disabled (A10 = LOW). 2. WRITE command can be issued to any valid bank and row address (WRITE command at T0 and T2 can be either same bank or different bank). 3. Interrupting WRITE command must be issued exactly 2 x tCK from previous WRITE. 4. Auto precharge can be either enabled (A10 = HIGH) or disabled (A10 = LOW) by the interrupting WRITE command. 5. NOP or COMMAND INHIBIT commands are valid. PRECHARGE command cannot be issued to banks used for WRITEs at T0 and T2. 6. Earliest WRITE-to-PRECHARGE timing for WRITE at T0 is WL + BL/2 + tWR where tWR starts with T7 and not T5 (since BL = 8 from MR and not the truncated length). 7. Example shown uses AL = 0; CL = 4, BL = 8. 8. Subsequent rising DQS signals must align to the clock within tDQSS. 58 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM WRITE Command Figure 40: WRITE-to-READ T0 T1 T2 COMMAND WRITE NOP NOP ADDRESS Bank a, Col b CK# T2n T3 T3n T4 T5 T6 T7 T8 READ NOP NOP T9 T9n CK tDQSS (NOM) NOP NOP NOP tWTR7 NOP Bank a, Col n WL ± tDQSS CL = 3 8 DQS, DQS# DI b DQ DIN DM tDQSS (MIN) WL - tDQSS CL = 3 8 DQS, DQS# DI b DQ DIN DM tDQSS (MAX) WL + tDQSS CL = 3 8 DQS, DQS# DI b DQ DIN DM DON’T CARE Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN TRANSITIONING DATA 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. DI b = data-in for column b; DOUT n = data-out from column n. BL = 4, AL = 0, CL = 3; thus, WL = 2. One subsequent element of data-in is applied in the programmed order following DI b. tWTR is referenced from the first positive CK edge after the last data-in pair. A10 is LOW with the WRITE command (auto precharge is disabled). The number of clock cycles required to meet tWTR is either 2 or tWTR/tCK, whichever is greater. 7. tWTR is required for any READ following a WRITE to the same device, but it is not required between module ranks. 8. Subsequent rising DQS signals must align to the clock within tDQSS. 59 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM WRITE Command Figure 41: WRITE-to-PRECHARGE T0 T1 T2 WRITE NOP NOP CK# T2n T3 T3n T4 T5 T6 T7 NOP NOP NOP PRE7 CK COMMAND NOP tWR ADDRESS Bank, (a or all) Bank a, Col b tDQSS (NOM) tRP WL + tDQSS 8 DQS# DQS DI b DQ DM tDQSS (MIN) WL - tDQSS 8 DQS# DQS DI b DQ DM tDQSS (MAX) WL + tDQSS 8 DQS# DQS DI b DQ DM DON’T CARE Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN TRANSITIONING DATA 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. DI b = data-in for column b. Three subsequent elements of data-in are applied in the programmed order following DI b. BL = 4, CL = 3, AL = 0; thus, WL = 2. tWR is referenced from the first positive CK edge after the last data-in pair. The PRECHARGE and WRITE commands are to the same bank. However, the PRECHARGE and WRITE commands may be to different banks, in which case tWR is not required and the PRECHARGE command could be applied earlier. 6. A10 is LOW with the WRITE command (auto precharge is disabled). 7. PRE = PRECHARGE command. 8. Subsequent rising DQS signals must align to the clock within tDQSS. 60 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM WRITE Command Figure 42: CK# Bank Write – without Auto Precharge T1 T0 T3 T4 T5 WRITE2 NOP6 NOP6 T2 CK tCK tCH T5n T6 T6n T7 T8 T9 NOP6 NOP6 PRE tCL CKE COMMAND5 NOP6 ACT NOP6 ADDRESS RA Col n A10 RA 3 NOP6 ALL BANKS ONE BANK BA0, BA1, BA2 Bank x Bank x4 Bank x tRCD tWR WL = 2 tRP tRAS WL ± tDQSS (NOM) 9 DQS, DQS# tWPRE tDQSL tDQSH tWPST DI n DQ1 DM DON’T CARE Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN TRANSITIONING DATA 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. DI n = data-in from column n; subsequent elements are applied in the programmed order. BL = 4, AL = 0, and WL = 2 in the case shown. Disable auto precharge. “Don’t Care” if A10 is HIGH at T9. PRE = PRECHARGE, ACT = ACTIVE, RA = row address, BA = bank address. NOP commands are shown for ease of illustration; other commands may be valid at these times. 7. tDSH is applicable during tDQSS (MIN) and is referenced from CK T5 or T6. 8. tDSS is applicable during tDQSS (MAX) and is referenced from CK T6 or T7. 9. Subsequent rising DQS signals must align to the clock within tDQSS. 61 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM WRITE Command Figure 43: CK# Bank Write – with Auto Precharge T1 T0 CK T2 tCK tCH T3 T4 T5 WRITE2 NOP5 NOP5 T5n T6 T6n T7 T8 T9 NOP5 NOP5 NOP5 tCL CKE COMMAND4 NOP5 ACT NOP5 RA ADDRESS NOP5 Col n 3 A10 BA0, BA1, BA2 RA Bank x Bank x tRCD WR8 WL = 2 tRP tRAS WL ± tDQSS (NOM) 9 DQS,DQS# tWPRE tDQSL tDQSH tWPST DI n DQ1 DM TRANSITIONING DATA Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN DON’T CARE DI n = data-in from column n; subsequent elements are applied in the programmed order. BL = 4, AL = 0, and WL = 2 in the case shown. Enable auto precharge. ACT = ACTIVE, RA = row address, BA = bank address. NOP commands are shown for ease of illustration; other commands may be valid at these times. tDSH is applicable during tDQSS (MIN) and is referenced from CK T5 or T6. tDSS is applicable during tDQSS (MAX) and is referenced from CK T6 or T7. WR is programmed via MR[11, 10, 9] and is calculated by dividing tWR (in nanoseconds) by tCK and rounding up to the next integer value. Subsequent rising DQS signals must align to the clock within tDQSS. 62 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM WRITE Command Figure 44: CK# CK WRITE – DM Operation T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 T6n T7 T7n T8 T9 NOP6 NOP6 T10 T11 tCH tCL tCK CKE COMMAND5 NOP6 ACT NOP6 WRITE2 ADDRESS RA Col n A10 RA 3 NOP6 AL = 1 NOP6 WL = 2 NOP6 NOP6 NOP6 PRE ALL BANKS ONE BANK BA0, BA1, BA2 Bank x Bank x4 Bank x tWR9 tRCD tRPA tRAS WL ± tDQSS (NOM) 10 DQS, DQS# tWPRE DQ tDQSL tDQSH tWPST DI n 1 DM TRANSITIONING DATA Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN DON’T CARE DI n = data-in from column n; subsequent elements are applied in the programmed order. Burst length = 4, AL = 1, and WL = 2 in the case shown. Disable auto precharge. “Don’t Care” if A10 is HIGH at T11. PRE = PRECHARGE, ACT = ACTIVE, RA = row address, BA = bank address. NOP commands are shown for ease of illustration; other commands may be valid at these times. tDSH is applicable during tDQSS (MIN) and is referenced from CK T6 or T7. t DSS is applicable during tDQSS (MAX) and is referenced from CK T7 or T8. t WR starts at the end of the data burst regardless of the data mask condition. Subsequent rising DQS signals must align to the clock within tDQSS. 63 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM WRITE Command Figure 45: Data Input Timing T0 T1 T1n T2 T2n T3 T3n T4 CK# CK tDSH1 tDSS2 WL - tDQSS (NOM) 6 DQS DQS# tWPRE DQ tDSH1 tDSS2 tDQSL tDQSH tWPST DI DM TRANSITIONING DATA Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. DON’T CARE tDSH (MIN) generally occurs during tDQSS (MIN). (MIN) generally occurs during tDQSS (MAX). WRITE command issued at T0. For x16, LDQS controls the lower byte and UDQS controls the upper byte. WRITE command with WL = 2 (CL = 3, AL = 0) issued at T0. Subsequent rising DQS signals must align to the clock within tDQSS. tDSS 64 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM PRECHARGE Command PRECHARGE Command The PRECHARGE command, illustrated in Figure 46, is used to deactivate the open row in a particular bank or the open row in all banks. The bank(s) will be available for a subsequent row activation a specified time (tRP) after the PRECHARGE command is issued, except in the case of concurrent auto precharge, where a READ or WRITE command to a different bank is allowed as long as it does not interrupt the data transfer in the current bank and does not violate any other timing parameters. Once a bank has been precharged, it is in the idle state and must be activated prior to any READ or WRITE commands being issued to that bank. A PRECHARGE command is allowed if there is no open row in that bank (idle state) or if the previously open row is already in the process of precharging. However, the precharge period will be determined by the last PRECHARGE command issued to the bank. PRECHARGE Operation Input A10 determines whether one or all banks are to be precharged, and in the case where only one bank is to be precharged, inputs BA2–BA0 select the bank. Otherwise BA2–BA0 are treated as “Don’t Care.” When all banks are to be precharged, inputs BA2–BA0 are treated as “Don’t Care.” Once a bank has been precharged, it is in the idle state and must be activated prior to any READ or WRITE commands being issued to that bank. tRPA timing applies when the PRECHARGE (ALL) command is issued, regardless of the number of banks already open or closed. If a single-bank PRECHARGE command is issued, tRP timing applies. tRPA (MIN) applies to all 8-bank DDR2 devices. Figure 46: PRECHARGE Command CK# CK CKE HIGH CS# RAS# CAS# WE# ADDRESS ALL BANKS A10 ONE BANK BA2, BA0, BA1 BA DON’T CARE Note: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN BA = bank address (if A10 is LOW; otherwise “Don’t Care”). 65 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM SELF REFRESH Command SELF REFRESH Command The SELF REFRESH command can be used to retain data in the DDR2 SDRAM, even if the rest of the system is powered down. When in the self refresh mode, the DDR2 SDRAM retains data without external clocking. All power supply inputs (including VREF ) must be maintained at valid levels upon entry/exit and during SELF REFRESH operation. The SELF REFRESH command is initiated like a REFRESH command except CKE is LOW. The DLL is automatically disabled upon entering self refresh and is automatically enabled upon exiting self refresh (200 clock cycles must then occur before a READ command can be issued). The differential clock should remain stable and meet tCKE specifications at least 1 x tCK after entering self refresh mode. All command and address input signals except CKE are “Don’t Care” during self refresh. The procedure for exiting self refresh requires a sequence of commands. First, the differential clock must be stable and meet tCK specifications at least 1 x tCK prior to CKE going back HIGH. Once CKE is HIGH (tCKE [MIN] has been satisfied with four clock registrations), the DDR2 SDRAM must have NOP or DESELECT commands issued for tXSNR because time is required for the completion of any internal refresh in progress. A simple algorithm for meeting both refresh and DLL requirements is to apply NOP or DESELECT commands for 200 clock cycles before applying any other command. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 66 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM SELF REFRESH Command Figure 47: Self Refresh T0 CK# CK1 T1 tCH tCL T2 Ta0 tCK1 Ta1 tCK1 Tb0 Ta2 tISXR6 Tc0 tCKE10 Td0 tIH CKE1 COMMAND5 NOP NOP7 REF NOP7 VALID3 VALID3 tIH ODT8 tAOFD / tAOFPD8 ADDRESS VALID VALID4 DQS#, DQS DQ DM tRP2 tXSNR3, 6, 11 tCKE (MIN)9 tXSRD4,6 Enter self refresh mode (synchronous) Notes: Exit self refresh mode (asynchronous) DON’T CARE Indicates a break in time scale 1. Clock must be stable and meeting tCK specifications at least 1 x tCK after entering self refresh mode and at least 1 x tCK prior to exiting self refresh mode. 2. Device must be in the all banks idle state prior to entering self refresh mode. 3. tXSNR is required before any non-READ command can be applied. 4. tXSRD (200 cycles of CK) is required before a READ command can be applied at state Td0. 5. REF = REFRESH command. 6. Self refresh exit is asynchronous; however, tXSNR and tXSRD timing starts at the first rising clock edge where CKE HIGH satisfies tISXR. 7. NOP or DESELECT commands are required prior to exiting self refresh until state Tc0, which allows any non-READ command. 8. ODT must be disabled and RTT off (tAOFD and tAOFPD have been satisfied) prior to entering SELF REFRESH at state T1. 9. Once self refresh has been entered, tCKE (MIN) must be satisfied prior to exiting self refresh. 10. CKE must stay HIGH until tXSRD is met; however, if self refresh is being re-entered, CKE may go back LOW after tXSNR is satisfied. 11. Once exiting SELF REFRESH, ODT must remain LOW until tXSRD is satisfied. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 67 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM REFRESH Command REFRESH Command REFRESH is used during normal operation of the DDR2 SDRAM and is analogous to CAS#-Before-RAS# (CBR) REFRESH. This command is nonpersistent, so it must be issued each time a refresh is required. The addressing is generated by the internal refresh controller. This makes the address bits a “Don’t Care” during an REFRESH command. The 1Gb DDR2 SDRAM requires REFRESH cycles at an average interval of 7.8125µs (MAX). To allow for improved efficiency in scheduling and switching between tasks, some flexibility in the absolute refresh interval is provided. A maximum of eight REFRESH commands can be posted (to defer issuing REFRESH commands) to any given DDR2 SDRAM, meaning that the maximum absolute interval between any REFRESH command and the next REFRESH command is 9 × 7.8125µs (70.3µs; 3.9µs for hightemperature operation). The refresh period begins when the REFRESH command is registered and ends tRFC (MIN) later. Figure 48: Refresh Mode T0 T2 T1 T3 T4 Ta0 Ta1 Tb0 Tb1 Tb2 NOP2 REF NOP2 REF5 NOP2 NOP2 ACT CK# CK tCK tCH tCL CKE COMMAND1 NOP 2 NOP2 PRE ADDRESS RA ALL BANKS A101 RA ONE BANK BANK1 Bank(s)3 BA DQS, DQS#4 DQ4 DM4 tRP tRFC(MIN) tRFC5 Indicates a break in time scale Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN DON’T CARE 1. PRE = PRECHARGE, ACT = ACTIVE, AR = REFRESH, RA = row address, BA = bank address. 2. NOP commands are shown for ease of illustration; other valid commands may be possible at these times. CKE must be active during clock positive transitions. 3. “Don’t Care” if A10 is HIGH at this point; A10 must be HIGH if more than one bank is active (i.e., must precharge all active banks). 4. DM, DQ, and DQS signals are all “Don’t Care”/High-Z for operations shown. 5. The second REFRESH is not required and is only shown as an example of two back-to-back REFRESH commands. 68 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Power-Down Mode Power-Down Mode DDR2 SDRAMs support multiple power-down modes that allow significant power savings over normal operating modes. CKE is used to enter and exit different powerdown modes. Power-down entry and exit timings are shown in Figure 49 on page 70. Detailed power-down entry conditions are shown in Figures 50 through 57. The CKE Truth Table, Table 12, is shown on page 71. DDR2 SDRAMs require CKE to be registered HIGH (active) at all times that an access is in progress—from the issuing of a READ or WRITE command until completion of the burst. Thus, a clock suspend is not supported. For READs, a burst completion is defined when the read postamble is satisfied; for WRITEs, a burst completion is defined when the write postamble and tWR or tWTR are satisfied, as shown in Figures 52 and 53 on page 73. The number of clock cycles required to meet tWTR is either two or tWTR/tCK, whichever is greater. Power-down mode (see Figure 49 on page 70) is entered when CKE is registered LOW coincident with a NOP or DESELECT command. CKE is not allowed to go LOW during a mode register or extended mode register command time, or while a READ or WRITE operation is in progress. If power-down occurs when all banks are idle, this mode is referred to as precharge power-down. If power-down occurs when there is a row active in any bank, this mode is referred to as active power-down. Entering power-down deactivates the input and output buffers, excluding CK, CK#, ODT, and CKE. For maximum power savings, the DLL is frozen during precharge power-down. Exiting active powerdown requires the device to be at the same voltage and frequency as when it entered power-down. Exiting precharge power-down requires the device to be at the same voltage as when it entered power-down; however, the clock frequency is allowed to change. See “Precharge Power-Down Clock Frequency Change” on page 76. The maximum duration for either active or precharge power-down is limited by the refresh requirements of the device tRFC (MAX). The minimum duration for power-down entry and exit is limited by the tCKE (MIN) parameter. While in power-down mode, CKE LOW, a stable clock signal, and stable power supply signals must be maintained at the inputs of the DDR2 SDRAM, while all other input signals are “Don’t Care” except ODT. Detailed ODT timing diagrams for different power-down modes are shown in Figures 60 through 67. The power-down state is synchronously exited when CKE is registered HIGH (in conjunction with an NOP or DESELECT command), as shown in Figure 49 on page 70. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 69 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Power-Down Mode Figure 49: Power-Down T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 T7 T8 NOP NOP VALID VALID CK# CK COMMAND tCK VALID1 tCH tCL NOP tCKE (MIN)3 tIH CKE tIH tCKE (MIN)3 tIS ADDRESS VALID VALID VALID tXP4, tXARD5 tXARDS6 DQS, DQS# DQ DM Enter power-down mode2 Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Exit power-down mode DON’T CARE 1. If this command is a PRECHARGE (or if the device is already in the idle state), then the power-down mode shown is precharge power-down. If this command is an ACTIVE (or if at least one row is already active), then the power-down mode shown is active power-down. 2. No column accesses are allowed to be in progress at the time power-down is entered. If the DLL was not in a locked state when CKE went LOW, the DLL must be reset after exiting power-down mode for proper READ operation. 3. tCKE (MIN) of three clocks means CKE must be registered on three consecutive positive clock edges. CKE must remain at the valid input level the entire time it takes to achieve the three clocks of registration. Thus, after any CKE transition, CKE may not transition from its valid level during the time period of tIS + 2 x tCK + tIH. CKE must not transition during its tIS and tIH window. 4. tXP timing is used for exit precharge power-down and active power-down to any non-READ command. 5. tXARD timing is used for exit active power-down to READ command if fast exit is selected via MR (bit 12 = 0). tXARDS timing is used for exit active power-down to READ command if slow exit is selected 6. via MR (bit 12 = 1). 70 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Power-Down Mode Table 12: CKE Truth Table Notes 1–3, 12 CKE Current State Power-down Bank(s) active L L L L H L H L H L All banks idle H L H H L H Self refresh Notes: Previous Current Cycle Cycle (n) (n-1) Command (n) CS#, RAS#, CAS#, WE# Action (n) Notes X Maintain power-down 13, 14 DESELECT or NOP Power-down exit 4, 8 X Maintain self refresh 14 DESELECT or NOP Self refresh exit 4, 5, 9 DESELECT or NOP Active power-down 4, 8, 10, 11 entry DESELECT or NOP Precharge power-down 4, 8, 10 entry REFRESH Self refresh entry 6, 9, 11 Shown in Table 6 on page 34 7 1. CKE (n) is the logic state of CKE at clock edge n; CKE (n-1) was the state of CKE at the previous clock edge. 2. Current state is the state of the DDR2 SDRAM immediately prior to clock edge n. 3. Command (n) is the command registered at clock edge n, and action (n) is a result of command (n). 4. All states and sequences not shown are illegal or reserved unless explicitly described elsewhere in this document. 5. On self refresh exit, DESELECT or NOP commands must be issued on every clock edge occurring during the tXSNR period. READ commands may be issued only after tXSRD (200 clocks) is satisfied. 6. Self refresh mode can only be entered from the all banks idle state. 7. Must be a legal command, as defined in Table 6 on page 34. 8. Valid commands for power-down entry and exit are NOP and DESELECT only. 9. Valid commands for self refresh exit are NOP and DESELECT only. 10. Power-down and self refresh can not be entered while READ or WRITE operations, LOAD MODE operations, or PRECHARGE operations are in progress. See “Power-Down Mode” on page 69 and See “SELF REFRESH Command” on page 66 for a list of detailed restrictions. 11. Minimum CKE HIGH time is tCKE = 3 x tCK. Minimum CKE LOW time is tCKE = 3 x tCK. This requires a minimum of 3 clock cycles of registration. 12. The state of ODT does not affect the states described in this table. The ODT function is not available during self refresh. See “ODT Timing” on page 79 for more details and specific restrictions. 13. Power-down modes do not perform any REFRESH operations. The duration of power-down mode is therefore limited by the refresh requirements. 14. “X” means “Don’t Care” (including floating around VREF) in self refresh and power-down. However, ODT must be driven HIGH or LOW in power-down if the ODT function is enabled via EMR(1). PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 71 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Power-Down Mode Figure 50: CK# READ to Power-Down or Self Refresh Entry T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 READ NOP NOP NOP VALID VALID T7 CK COMMAND NOP2 tCKE (MIN) CKE ADDRESS VALID A10 DQS, DQS# DQ DOUT RL = 3 DOUT DOUT DOUT Power-down1 or self refresh entry Notes: Figure 51: CK# DON’T CARE TRANSITIONING DATA 1. Power-down or self refresh entry may occur after the READ burst completes. 2. In the example shown, READ burst completes at T5; earliest power-down or self refresh entry is at T6. READ with Auto Precharge to Power-Down or Self Refresh Entry T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 READ NOP NOP NOP VALID VALID NOP2 T7 CK COMMAND tCKE (MIN) CKE ADDRESS VALID A10 DQS, DQS# DQ RL = 3 DOUT DOUT DOUT DOUT Power-down TRANSITIONING DATA or self refresh1 entry Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN DON’T CARE 1. Power-down or self refresh entry may occur after the READ burst completes. 2. In the example shown, READ burst completes at T5; earliest power-down or self refresh entry is at T6. 72 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Power-Down Mode Figure 52: T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 T7 WRITE NOP NOP NOP VALID VALID VALID NOP1 CK# CK COMMAND WRITE to Power-Down or Self-Refresh Entry T8 tCKE (MIN) CKE ADDRESS VALID A10 DQS, DQS# DQ DOUT WL = 3 DOUT DOUT DOUT tWTR TRANSITIONING DATA Notes: Figure 53: CK# CK COMMAND Power-down or self refresh entry1 DON’T CARE 1. Power-down or self refresh entry may occur after the WRITE burst completes. WRITE with Auto Precharge to Power-Down or Self Refresh Entry T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 Ta0 Ta1 WRITE NOP NOP NOP VALID VALID VALID2 NOP Ta2 tCKE (MIN) CKE ADDRESS VALID A10 DQS, DQS# DQ DOUT WL = 3 DOUT DOUT DOUT WR1 TRANSITIONING DATA Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN DON’T CARE Indicates a break in time scale Power-down or self refresh entry 1. WR is programmed through MR[9, 10, 11] and represents (tWR [MIN] ns / tCK) rounded up to next integer tCK. 2. Internal PRECHARGE occurs at Ta0 when WR has completed; power-down entry may occur 1 x tCK later at Ta1, prior to tRP being satisfied. 73 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Power-Down Mode Figure 54: REFRESH Command to Power-Down Entry CK# T0 T1 T2 VALID REFRESH NOP T3 CK COMMAND t CKE (MIN) CKE 1 x tCK DON’T CARE Power-down1 entry Notes: Figure 55: 1. The earliest precharge power-down entry may occur is at T2 which is 1 x tCK after the REFRESH command. Precharge power down entry occurs prior to tRFC (MIN) being satisfied. ACTIVE Command to Power-Down Entry CK# T0 T1 T2 VALID ACTIVE NOP T3 CK COMMAND ADDRESS VALID tCKE (MIN) CKE 1 tCK DON’T CARE Power-down1 entry Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 1. The earliest active power-down entry may occur is at T2, which is 1 x tCK after the ACTIVE command. Active power-down entry occurs prior to tRCD (MIN) being satisfied. 74 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Power-Down Mode Figure 56: PRECHARGE Command to Power-Down Entry CK# T0 T1 T2 VALID PRECHARGE NOP T3 CK COMMAND ADDRESS VALID ALL BANKS vs SINGLE BANK A10 tCKE (MIN) CKE 1 x tCK Power-down1 entry Notes: Figure 57: DON’T CARE 1. The earliest precharge power-down entry may occur is at T2, which is 1 x tCK after the PRECHARGE command. Precharge power-down entry occurs prior to tRP (MIN) being satisfied. LOAD MODE Command to Power-Down Entry T0 T1 T2 T3 LM NOP NOP T4 CK# CK COMMAND VALID VALID3 ADDRESS tCKE (MIN) CKE tRP2 tMRD Power-down1 entry Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN DON’T CARE 1. The earliest precharge power-down entry is at T3, which is after tMRD is satisfied. 2. All banks must be in the precharged state and tRP met prior to issuing LM command. 3. Valid address for LM command includes MR, EMR, EMR(2), and EMR(3) registers. 75 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Precharge Power-Down Clock Frequency Change Precharge Power-Down Clock Frequency Change When the DDR2 SDRAM is in precharge power-down mode, ODT must be turned off and CKE must be at a logic LOW level. A minimum of two differential clock cycles must pass after CKE goes LOW before clock frequency may change. The device input clock frequency is allowed to change only within minimum and maximum operating frequencies specified for the particular speed grade. During input clock frequency change, ODT and CKE must be held at stable LOW levels. Once the input clock frequency is changed, new stable clocks must be provided to the device before precharge power-down may be exited, and DLL must be reset via EMR after precharge power-down exit. Depending on the new clock frequency, an additional LM command might be required to appropriately set the WR MR[11, 10, 9]. During the DLL relock period of 200 cycles, ODT must remain off. After the DLL lock time, the DRAM is ready to operate with a new clock frequency. Figure 58: Input Clock Frequency Change During Precharge Power-Down Mode PREVIOUS CLOCK FREQUENCY T0 T1 T2 NEW CLOCK FREQUENCY T3 Ta1 Ta0 Ta2 Ta3 Ta4 Tb0 NOP VALID CK# CK tCH tCH tCL tCL tCK tCK 2 x tCK (MIN)2 1 x tCK (MIN)3 tCKE (MIN)4 CKE COMMAND ADDR tCKE (MIN)4 VALID1 NOP NOP NOP VALID LM DLL RESET VALID tXP ODT DQS, DQS# High-Z DQ High-Z DM Enter precharge power-down mode Frequency change Exit precharge power-down mode 200 x tCK Indicates a break in time scale Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN DON’T CARE 1. If this command is a PRECHARGE (or if the device is already in the idle state), then the power-down mode shown is precharge power-down, which is required prior to the clock frequency change. 2. A minimum of 2 x tCK is required after entering precharge power-down prior to changing clock frequencies. 3. Once the new clock frequency has changed and is stable, a minimum of 1 x tCK is required prior to exiting precharge power-down. 4. Minimum CKE HIGH time is tCKE = 3 x tCK. Minimum CKE LOW time is tCKE = 3 x tCK. This requires a minimum of three clock cycles of registration. 76 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM RESET Function RESET Function (CKE LOW Anytime) DDR2 SDRAM applications may go into a reset state anytime during normal operation. If an application enters a reset condition, CKE is used to ensure the DDR2 SDRAM device resumes normal operation after re-initializing. All data will be lost during a reset condition; however, the DDR2 SDRAM device will continue to operate properly if the following conditions outlined in this section are satisfied. The reset condition defined here assumes all supply voltages (VDD, VDDQ, VDDL, and VREF ) are stable and meet all DC specifications prior to, during, and after the RESET operation. All other input pins of the DDR2 SDRAM device are a “Don’t Care” during RESET with the exception of CKE. If CKE asynchronously drops LOW during any valid operation (including a READ or WRITE burst), the memory controller must satisfy the timing parameter tDELAY before turning off the clocks. Stable clocks must exist at the CK, CK# inputs of the DRAM before CKE is raised HIGH, at which time the normal initialization sequence must occur. See “Initialization” on page 21. The DDR2 SDRAM device is now ready for normal operation after the initialization sequence. Figure 59 on page 78 shows the proper sequence for a RESET operation. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 77 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM RESET Function Figure 59: RESET Function T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 Tb0 Ta0 tCK CK# CK tCL tDELAY tCL tCKE (MIN) 6 CKE ODT COMMAND2 READ NOP1 READ NOP1 NOP1 NOP1 PRE DM3 ADDRESS Col n Col n ALL BANKS A10 BA0, BA1, BA2 Bank a DQS3 High-Z DQ3 High-Z Bank b 5 High-Z DOUT High-Z DOUT DOUT High-Z RTT System RESET T = 400ns (MIN) tRP A Start of normal4 initialization sequence Indicates a break in time scale Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Unknown RTT ON DON’T CARE TRANSITIONING DATA 1. Either NOP or DESELECT command may be applied. 2. PRE = PRECHARGE command. 3. DM represents DM for x4/x8 configuration and UDM, LDM for x16 configuration. DQS represents DQS, DQS#, UDQS, UDQS#, LDQS, LDQS#, RDQS, RDQS# for the appropriate configuration (x4, x8, x16). 4. Initialization timing is shown in Figure 10 on page 21. 5. In certain cases where a READ cycle is interrupted, CKE going HIGH may result in the completion of the burst. 6. VDD, VDDL, VDDQ, VTT, and VREF must be valid at all times. 78 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM ODT Timing ODT Timing Once a 12ns delay (tMOD) has been satisfied, and after the ODT function has been enabled via the EMR LOAD MODE command, ODT can be accessed under two timing categories. ODT will operate in either synchronous mode or asynchronous mode, depending on the state of CKE. ODT can switch anytime except during self refresh mode and a few clocks after being enabled via EMR, as shown in Figure 60 on page 80. There are two timing categories for ODT—turn-on and turn-off. During active mode (CKE HIGH) and fast-exit power-down mode (any row of any bank open, CKE LOW, MR[12 = 0]), tAOND, tAON, tAOFD, and tAOF timing parameters are applied, as shown in Figure 62 on page 81 and Table 13 on page 81. During slow-exit power-down mode (any row of any bank open, CKE LOW, MR[12] = 1) and precharge power-down mode (all banks/rows precharged and idle, CKE LOW), tAONPD and tAOFPD timing parameters are applied, as shown in Figure 63 on page 82 and Table 14 on page 82. ODT turn-off timing, prior to entering any power-down mode, is determined by the parameter tANPD (MIN), as shown in Figure 64 on page 83. At state T2, the ODT HIGH signal satisfies tANPD (MIN) prior to entering power-down mode at T5. When tANPD (MIN) is satisfied, tAOFD and tAOF timing parameters apply. Figure 64 on page 83 also shows the example where tANPD (MIN) is not satisfied since ODT HIGH does not occur until state T3. When tANPD (MIN) is not satisfied, tAOFPD timing parameters apply. ODT turn-on timing prior to entering any power-down mode is determined by the parameter tANPD, as shown in Figure 65 on page 84. At state T2, the ODT HIGH signal satisfies tANPD (MIN) prior to entering power-down mode at T5. When tANPD (MIN) is satisfied, tAOND and tAON timing parameters apply. Figure 65 also shows the example where tANPD (MIN) is not satisfied since ODT HIGH does not occur until state T3. When tANPD (MIN) is not satisfied, tAONPD timing parameters apply. ODT turn-off timing after exiting any power-down mode is determined by the parameter tAXPD (MIN), as shown in Figure 66 on page 85. At state Ta1, the ODT LOW signal satis- fies tAXPD (MIN) after exiting power-down mode at state T1. When tAXPD (MIN) is satisfied, tAOFD and tAOF timing parameters apply. Figure 66 also shows the example where t AXPD (MIN) is not satisfied since ODT LOW occurs at state Ta0. When tAXPD (MIN) is not satisfied, tAOFPD timing parameters apply. ODT turn-on timing after exiting either slow-exit power-down mode or precharge power-down mode is determined by the parameter tAXPD (MIN), as shown in Figure 67 on page 86. At state Ta1, the ODT HIGH signal satisfies tAXPD (MIN) after exiting powerdown mode at state T1. When tAXPD (MIN) is satisfied, tAOND and tAON timing parameters apply. Figure 67 also shows the example where tAXPD (MIN) is not satisfied since ODT HIGH occurs at state Ta0. When tAXPD (MIN) is not satisfied, tAONPD timing parameters apply. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 79 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM ODT Timing Figure 60: ODT Timing for Entering and Exiting Power-Down Mode Synchronous Synchronous or Synchronous Asynchronous tANPD (3 tCKs) 1st CKE latched LOW tAXPD (8 tCKs) 1st CKE latched HIGH CKE Any mode except self refresh mode Any mode except self refresh mode Active power-down fast (synchronous) Active power-down slow (asynchronous) Precharge power-down (asynchronous) Applicable modes tAOND/tAOFD tAOND/tAOFD tAOND/tAOFD (synchronous) tAONPD/tAOFPD (asynchronous) Applicable timing parameters MRS Command to ODT Update Delay During normal operation, the value of the effective termination resistance can be changed with an EMRS set command. tMOD (MAX) updates the RTT setting. Figure 61: Timing for MRS Command to ODT Update Delay CMD EMRS1 NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP CK# CK 2 ODT2 tAOFD tMOD tIS 0ns Internal RTT Setting Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Old Setting Undefined New Setting 1. LM command directed to mode register, which updates the information in EMR(1)[A6, A2], i.e., RTT (nominal). 2. To prevent any impedance glitch on the channel, the following conditions must be met: tAOFD must be met before issuing the LM command; ODT must remain LOW for the entire duration of the tMOD window, until tMOD is met. 80 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM ODT Timing Figure 62: ODT Timing for Active or Fast-Exit Power-Down Mode T0 CK# CK T1 tCK tCH T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 tCL CMD VALID VALID VALID VALID VALID VALID VALID ADDR VALID VALID VALID VALID VALID VALID VALID CKE tAOND ODT tAOFD RTT tAON (MIN) tAOF (MAX) tAOF (MIN) tAON (MAX) RTT Unknown Table 13: RTT On DON’T CARE DDR2-400/533 ODT Timing for Active and Fast-Exit Power-Down Modes Parameter ODT turn-on delay ODT turn-on ODT turn-off delay ODT turn-off Note: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Symbol Min Max Units tAOND 2 tAC (MIN) 2.5 tAC (MIN) 2 tAC (MAX) + 1,000 2.5 tAC (MAX) + 600 tCK tAON tAOFD tAOF ps tCK ps The half-clock of tAOFD’s 2.5 tCK assumes a 50/50 clock duty cycle. This half-clock value must be derated by the amount of half-clock duty cycle error. For example, if the clock duty cycle was 47/53, tAOFD would actually be 2.5 - 0.03, or 2.47, for tAOF (MIN) and 2.5 + 0.03, or 2.53, for tAOF (MAX). 81 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM ODT Timing Figure 63: ODT Timing for Slow-Exit or Precharge Power-Down Modes CK# T0 CK T1 tCK tCH T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 T7 tCL CMD VALID VALID VALID VALID VALID VALID VALID VALID ADDR VALID VALID VALID VALID VALID VALID VALID VALID CKE ODT tAONPD (MAX) tAONPD (MIN) RTT tAOFPD (MIN) tAOFPD (MAX) Transitioning RTT Table 14: RTT Unknown RTT On DON’T CARE DDR2-400/533 ODT Timing for Slow-Exit and Precharge Power-Down Modes PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Parameter Symbol ODT turn-on (power-down mode) ODT turn-off (power-down mode) tAONPD tAC (MIN) + 2,000 tAOFPD tAC (MIN) + 2,000 82 Min Max 2x tCK +tAC (MAX) + 1,000 2.5 x tCK + tAC (MAX) + 1,000 Units ps ps Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM ODT Timing Figure 64: ODT Turn-off Timings When Entering Power-Down Mode T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP CK# CK tANPD (MIN) CKE tAOFD ODT tAOF (MAX) RTT tAOF (MIN) tAOFPD (MAX) ODT RTT tAOFPD (MIN) Transitioning RTT Table 15: RTT Unknown RTT On DON’T CARE DDR2-400/533 ODT Turn-off Timings When Entering Power-Down Mode Parameter ODT turn-off delay ODT turn-off ODT turn-off (power-down mode) ODT to power-down entry latency Note: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Symbol Min tAOFD 2.5 (MIN) tAC (MIN) + 2,000 3 tAOF tAOFPD t ANPD tAC Max Units 2.5 (MAX) + 600 2.5 x tCK + tAC (MAX) + 1,000 tCK tAC ps ps t CK The half-clock of tAOFD’s 2.5 tCK assumes a 50/50 clock duty cycle. This half-clock value must be derated by the amount of half-clock duty cycle error. For example, if the clock duty cycle was 47/53, tAOFD would actually be 2.5 - 0.03, or 2.47, for tAOF (MIN) and 2.5 + 0.03, or 2.53, for tAOF (MAX). 83 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM ODT Timing Figure 65: ODT Turn-On Timing When Entering Power-Down Mode CK# T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP CK t ANPD (MIN) CKE tAOND ODT tAON (MAX) RTT t AON (MIN) ODT tAONPD (MAX) tAONPD (MIN) RTT RTT Unknown Transitioning RTT Table 16: RTT On DON’T CARE DDR2-400/533 ODT Turn-on Timing When Entering Power-Down Mode Parameter Symbol ODT turn-on delay ODT turn-on ODT turn-on (power-down mode) ODT to power-down entry latency PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 84 t AOND tAON tAONPD tANPD Min Max 2 tAC (MIN) tAC (MIN) + 2,000 3 2 tAC (MAX) + 1,000 2 x tCK + tAC (MAX) + 1,000 Units t CK ps ps tCK Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM ODT Timing Figure 66: CK# ODT Turn-Off Timing When Exiting Power-Down Mode T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 Ta0 Ta1 Ta2 Ta3 Ta4 Ta5 NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP CK COMMAND tAXPD (MIN) CKE tCKE (MIN) tAOFD ODT tAOF (MAX) RTT tAOF (MIN) tAOFPD (MAX) ODT RTT tAOFPD (MIN) Transitioning RTT Table 17: RTT Unknown RTT On DON’T CARE Indicates a break in time scale DDR2-400/533 ODT Turn-off Timing When Exiting Power-Down Mode Parameter ODT turn-off delay ODT turn-off ODT turn-off (power-down mode) ODT to power-down exit latency Note: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Symbol Min Max Units tAOFD 2.5 tAC (MIN) t AC (MIN) + 2,000 8 2.5 tAC (MAX) + 600 2.5 x tCK + tAC (MAX) + 1,000 tCK tAOF t AOFPD tAXPD ps ps tCK The half-clock of tAOFD’s 2.5 tCK assumes a 50/50 clock duty cycle. This half-clock value must be derated by the amount of half-clock duty cycle error. For example, if the clock duty cycle was 47/53, tAOFD would actually be 2.5 - 0.03, or 2.47, for tAOF (MIN) and 2.5 + 0.03, or 2.53, fortAOF (MAX). 85 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM ODT Timing Figure 67: ODT Turn-on Timing When Exiting Power-Down Mode CK# T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 Ta0 Ta1 Ta2 Ta3 Ta4 Ta5 NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP NOP CK COMMAND tAXPD (MIN) CKE tCKE (MIN) tAOND ODT tAON (MAX) RTT tAON (MIN) tAONPD (MAX) ODT RTT tAONPD (MIN) Transitioning RTT Table 18: RTT Unknown RTT On Indicates a break in time scale DON’T CARE DDR2-400/533 ODT Turn-On Timing When Exiting Power-Down Mode Parameter ODT turn-on delay ODT turn-on ODT turn-on (power-down mode) ODT to power-down exit latency PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 86 Symbol Min tAOND 2 (MIN) tAC (MIN) + 2,000 8 tAON tAONPD t AXPD tAC Max 2 (MAX) + 1,000 2 x tCK + tAC (MAX) + 1,000 tAC Units tCK ps ps t CK Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Absolute Maximum Ratings Absolute Maximum Ratings Stresses greater than those listed may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only, and functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions above those indicated in the operational sections of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect reliability. Table 17: Absolute Maximum DC Ratings Parameter Symbol Min Max Units Notes VDD VDD supply voltage relative to VSS VDDQ VDDQ supply voltage relative to VSSQ VDDL VDDL supply voltage relative to VSSL VIN, VOUT Voltage on any ball relative to VSS II Input leakage current; any input 0V ≤ VIN ≤ VDD; all other balls not under test = 0V) IOZ Output leakage current; 0V ≤ VOUT ≤ VDDQ; DQ and ODT disabled IVREF VREF leakage current; VREF = Valid VREF level –1.0 –0.5 –0.5 –0.5 –5 2.3 2.3 2.3 2.3 5 V V V V µA 1 1, 2 1 3 –5 –2 5 2 µA µA Notes: 1. VDD, VDDQ, and VDDL must be within 300mV of each other at all times. 2. VREF ≤ 0.6 x VDDQ; however, VREF may be ≥ VDDQ provided that VREF ≤ 300mV. 3. Voltage on any I/O may not exceed voltage on VDDQ. Temperature and Thermal Impedance It is imperative that the DDR2 SDRAM device’s temperature specifications, shown in Table 18 on page 88, be maintained in order to ensure the junction temperature is in the proper operating range to meet data sheet specifications. An important step in maintaining the proper junction temperature is using the device’s thermal impedances correctly. The thermal impedances are listed in Table 19 on page 88 for the applicable and available die revision and packages. Incorrectly using thermal impedances can produce significant errors. Read Micron technical note TN-00-08, “Thermal Applications,” prior to using the thermal impedances listed below. For designs that are expected to last several years and require the flexibility to use several designs, consider using final target theta values, rather than existing values, to account for larger thermal impedances. The DDR2 SDRAM device’s safe junction temperature range can be maintained when the TCASE (TC) specification is not exceeded. In applications where the device’s ambient temperature is too high, use of forced air and/or heat sinks may be required in order to satisfy the case temperature specifications. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 87 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Temperature and Thermal Impedance Table 18: Temperature Limits Parameter Storage temperature Operating temperature – commercial Operating temperature – industrial Notes: Table 19: Package Substrate A 92-ball D1 68-ball 2-layer 4-layer 2-layer 4-layer 2-layer 4-layer 2-layer 4-layer 2-layer 4-layer 38.3 24.7 46.6 32.8 46.6 32.8 60.0 39.0 55.0 38.0 84-ball 68-ball 84-ball Notes: Figure 68: Max Units Notes TSTG TC TC TAMB –55 0 –40 –40 100 85 95 85 °C °C °C °C 1 2, 3 2, 3, 4 4, 5 Thermal Impedance 1 Last shrink target2 Min 1. MAX storage case temperature; TSTG is measured in the center of the package, as shown in Figure 68. This case temperature limit is allowed to be exceeded briefly during package reflow, as noted in Micron technical note TN-00-15, “Recommended Soldering Parameters.” 2. MAX operating case temperature; TC is measured in the center of the package, as shown in Figure 68. 3. Device functionality is not guaranteed if the device exceeds maximum TC during operation. 4. Both temperature specifications must be satisfied. 5. Operating ambient temperature surrounding the package. θ JA (°C/W) Airflow = 0m/s Die Rev Symbol θ JA (°C/W) Airflow = 1m/s θ JA (°C/W) Airflow = 2m/s θ JB (°C/W) θ JC (°C/W) 25.3 18.1 33.5 26.1 33.5 26.1 48.0 34.0 42.0 32.0 21.3 16.0 28.7 23.3 28.7 23.3 45.0 32.0 37.0 30.0 11.8 10.8 18.3 18.0 18.3 18.0 22.0 22.0 22.0 21.0 1.7 2.5 2.5 6.0 6.0 1. Thermal resistance data is based on a number of samples from multiple lots and should be viewed as a typical number. 2. This is an estimate; simulated number and actual results could vary. Example Temperature Test Point Location Test Point Test Point 16.50 19.0 6.75 9.5 5.00 5.5 10.00 11.00 11mm x 19mm “BT” FGBA PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 10mm x 16.5 mm “B7” FBGA 88 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM AC and DC Operating Conditions AC and DC Operating Conditions Table 20: Recommended DC Operating Conditions (SSTL_18) All voltages referenced to VSS Parameter Symbol Min Nom Max Units Notes Supply voltage VDDL supply voltage I/O supply voltage I/O reference voltage I/O termination voltage (system) VDD VDDL VDDQ VREF(DC) VTT 1.7 1.7 1.7 0.49 x VDDQ VREF(DC) - 40 1.8 1.8 1.8 0.50 x VDDQ VREF(DC) 1.9 1.9 1.9 0.51 X VDDQ VREF(DC) + 40 V V V V mV 1, 5 4, 5 4, 5 2 3 Notes: Table 21: 1. VDD and VDDQ must track each other. VDDQ must be ≤ VDD. 2. VREF is expected to equal VDDQ/2 of the transmitting device and to track variations in the DC level of the same. Peak-to-peak noise (non-common mode) on VREF may not exceed ±1 percent of the DC value. Peak-to-peak AC noise on VREF may not exceed ±2 percent of VREF(DC). This measurement is to be taken at the nearest VREF bypass capacitor. 3. VTT is not applied directly to the device. VTT is a system supply for signal termination resistors, is expected to be set equal to VREF, and must track variations in the DC level of VREF. 4. VDDQ tracks with VDD; VDDL tracks with VDD. 5. VSSQ = VSSL = VSS. ODT DC Electrical Characteristics All voltages referenced to VSS Parameter Symbol Min Nom Max Units Notes RTT effective impedance value for 75Ω setting EMR (A6, A2) = 0, 1 RTT effective impedance value for 150Ω setting EMR (A6, A2) = 1, 0 RTT effective impedance value for 50Ω setting EMR (A6, A2) = 1, 1 Deviation of VM with respect to VDDQ/2 RTT1(EFF) 60 75 90 Ω 1, 3 RTT2(EFF) 120 150 180 Ω 1, 3 RTT3(EFF) 40 50 60 Ω 1, 3 ΔVM –6 6 % 2 Notes: 1. RTT1(EFF) and RTT2(EFF) are determined by separately applying VIH(AC) and VIL(AC) to the ball being tested, and then measuring current, I(VIH(AC)), and I(VIL(AC)), respectively. V IH ( AC ) – V IL ( AC ) R TT ( EFF ) = ------------------------------------------------------------I ( V IH ( AC ) ) – I ( V IL ( AC ) ) 2. Measure voltage (VM) at tested ball with no load. 2 × VM ΔVM = ⎛⎝ ------------------ – 1⎞⎠ × 100 V DD Q 3. IT device minimum values are derated by six percent when device operates between –40°C and 0°C (TC). PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 89 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Electrical Characteristics and Operating Conditions Input Electrical Characteristics and Operating Conditions Table 22: Input DC Logic Levels All voltages referenced to VSS Parameter Input HIGH (logic 1) voltage Input LOW (logic 0) voltage Table 23: Symbol Min Max Units VIH(DC) VIL(DC) VREF(DC) + 125 –300 VDDQ + 300 VREF(DC) - 125 mV mV Input AC Logic Levels All voltages referenced to VSS Parameter Input HIGH (logic 1) voltage (-5E/-37E) Input HIGH (logic 1) voltage (-3/-3E/-25/-25E) Input LOW (logic 0) voltage (-5E/-37E) Input LOW (logic 0) voltage (-3/-3E/-25/-25E) Figure 69: Symbol Min Max Units VIH(AC) VIH(AC) VIL(AC) VIL(AC) VREF(DC) + 250 VREF(DC) + 200 – – – – VREF(DC) - 250 VREF(DC) - 200 mV mV mV mV Single-Ended Input Signal Levels Note: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 1,150mV VIH(AC) 1,025mV VIH(DC) 936mV 918mV 900mV 882mV 864mV VREF + AC Noise VREF + DC Error VREF - DC Error VREF - AC Noise 775mV VIL(DC) 650mV VIL(AC) Numbers in diagram reflect nominal values. 90 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Electrical Characteristics and Operating Conditions Table 24: Differential Input Logic Levels All voltages referenced to VSS Parameter Symbol Min Max Units Notes DC input signal voltage DC differential input voltage AC differential input voltage AC differential cross-point voltage Input midpoint voltage VIN(DC) VID(DC) VID(AC) VIX(AC) VMP(DC) –300 250 500 0.50 x VDDQ - 175 850 VDDQ + 300 VDDQ + 600 VDDQ + 600 0.50 x VDDQ + 175 950 mV mV mV mV mV 1 2 3 4 5 Notes: Figure 70: 1. VIN(DC) specifies the allowable DC execution of each input of differential pair such as CK, CK#, DQS, DQS#, LDQS, LDQS#, UDQS, UDQS#, and RDQS, RDQS#. 2. VID(DC) specifies the input differential voltage | VTR - VCP | required for switching, where VTR is the true input (such as CK, DQS, LDQS, UDQS) level and VCP is the complementary input (such as CK#, DQS#, LDQS#, UDQS#). The minimum value is equal to VIH(DC) - VIL(DC). Differential input signal levels are shown in Figure 70. 3. VID(AC) specifies the input differential voltage | VTR - VCP | required for switching, where VTR is the true input (such as CK, DQS, LDQS, UDQS, RDQS) level and VCP is the complementary input (such as CK#, DQS#, LDQS#, UDQS#, RDQS#). The minimum value is equal to VIH(AC) VIL(AC), as shown in Table 23 on page 90. 4. The typical value of VIX(AC) is expected to be about 0.5 x VDDQ of the transmitting device and VIX(AC) is expected to track variations in VDDQ. VIX(AC) indicates the voltage at which differential input signals must cross, as shown in Figure 70. 5. VMP(DC) specifies the input differential common mode voltage (VTR + VCP)/2 where VTR is the true input (CK, DQS) level and VCP is the complementary input (CK#, DQS#). VMP(DC) is expected to be approximately 0.5 x VDDQ. Differential Input Signal Levels VIN(DC) MAX5 2.1V @ VDDQ = 1.8V CP8 X 1.075V VMP(DC)1 0.9V 0.725 V VIX(AC) 2 VID(DC)3 VID(AC)4 X TR8 5 VIN(DC) MIN - 0.30V Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. This provides a minimum of 850mV to a maximum of 950mV and is expected to be VDDQ/2. TR and CP must cross in this region. TR and CP must meet at least VID(DC) MIN when static and is centered around VMP(DC). TR and CP must have a minimum 500mV peak-to-peak swing. TR and CP may not be more positive than VDDQ + 0.3V or more negative than VSS - 0.3V. For AC operation, all DC clock requirements must also be satisfied. Numbers in diagram reflect nominal values (VDDQ = 1.8V). TR represents the CK, DQS, RDQS, LDQS, and UDQS signals; CP represents CK#, DQS#, RDQS#, LDQS#, and UDQS# signals. 91 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Electrical Characteristics and Operating Conditions Table 25: AC Input Test Conditions Parameter Symbol Input setup timing measurement reference level BA2–BA0, A0–A12 A0–A13 (A12 x16) A0–A13 A0–A14, CS#, RAS#, CAS#, WE#, ODT, DM, UDM, LDM, and CKE Input hold timing measurement reference level BA2–BA0, A0–A12 A0–A13 (A12 x16) A0–A13 A0–A14, CS#, RAS#, CAS#, WE#, ODT, DM, UDM, LDM, and CKE Input timing measurement reference level (single-ended) DQS for x4, x8; UDQS, LDQS for x16 Input timing measurement reference level (differential) CK, CK# for x4, x8, x16 DQS, DQS# for x4, x8; RDQS, RDQS# for x8 UDQS, UDQS#, LDQS, LDQS# for x16 Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Min Max Units Notes VRS See Note 2 1, 2, 7, 8 VRH See Note 3 1, 3, 7, 8 VREF(DC) VRD VDDQ x 0.49 VDDQ x 0.51 VIX(AC) V V 1, 4, 7, 8 1, 5, 6, 7, 9 1. All voltages referenced to VSS. 2. Input waveform setup timing (tISb) is referenced from the input signal crossing at the VIH(AC) level for a rising signal and VIL(AC) for a falling signal applied to the device under test, as shown in Figure 79 on page 107. 3. Input waveform hold (tIHb) timing is referenced from the input signal crossing at the VIL(DC) level for a rising signal and VIH(DC) for a falling signal applied to the device under test, as shown in Figure 79 on page 107. 4. Input waveform setup timing (tDS) and hold timing (tDH) for single-ended data strobe is referenced from the crossing of DQS, UDQS, or LDQS through the VREF level applied to the device under test, as shown in Figure 81 on page 108. 5. Input waveform setup timing (tDS) and hold timing (tDH) when differential data strobe is enabled is referenced from the cross-point of DQS/DQS#, UDQS/UDQS#, or LDQS/LDQS#, as shown in Figure 80 on page 107. 6. Input waveform timing is referenced to the crossing point level (VIX) of two input signals (VTR and VCP) applied to the device under test, where VTR is the “true” input signal and VCP is the complementary input signal, as shown in Figure 82 on page 108. 7. See “Input Slew Rate Derating” on page 93. 8. The slew rate for single-ended inputs is measured from DC-level to AC-level, (VIL(DC) to VIH(AC) on the rising edge and VIL(AC) to VIH(DC) on the falling edge. For signals referenced to VREF, the valid intersection is where the “tangent” line intersects VREF, as shown in Figures 72, 74, 76, and 78. 9. The slew rate for differentially ended inputs is measured from twice the DC-level to twice the AC-level: 2 x VIL(DC) to 2 x VIH(AC) on the rising edge and 2 x VIL(AC) to 2 x VIH(DC) on the falling edge). For example, the CK/CK# would be –250mV to +500mV for CK rising edge and would be +250mV to –500mV for CK falling edge. 92 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Slew Rate Derating Input Slew Rate Derating For all input signals, the total tIS (setup time) and tIH (hold time) required is calculated by adding the data sheet tIS (base) and tIH (base) value to the ΔtIS and ΔtIH derating value, respectively. Example: tIS (total setup time) = tIS (base) + ΔtIS. t IS, the nominal slew rate for a rising signal, is defined as the slew rate between the last crossing of VREF(DC) and the first crossing of VIH(AC) MIN. Setup nominal slew rate (tIS) for a falling signal is defined as the slew rate between the last crossing of VREF(DC) and the first crossing of VIL(AC) MAX. If the actual signal is always earlier than the nominal slew rate line between shaded “VREF(DC) to AC region,” use nominal slew rate for derating value (Figure 71 on page 95). If the actual signal is later than the nominal slew rate line anywhere between shaded “VREF(DC) to AC region,” the slew rate of a tangent line to the actual signal from the AC level to DC level is used for derating value (see Figure 72 on page 96). t IH, the nominal slew rate for a rising signal, is defined as the slew rate between the last crossing of VIL(DC) MAX and the first crossing of VREF(DC). tIH, nominal slew rate for a falling signal, is defined as the slew rate between the last crossing of VIH(DC) MIN and the first crossing of VREF(DC). If the actual signal is always later than the nominal slew rate line between shaded “DC to VREF(DC) region,” use nominal slew rate for derating value (Figure 73 on page 97). If the actual signal is earlier than the nominal slew rate line anywhere between shaded “DC to VREF(DC)) region,” the slew rate of a tangent line to the actual signal from the DC level to VREF(DC) level is used for the derating value (Figure 74 on page 98). Although the total setup time might be negative for slow slew rates (a valid input signal will not have reached VIH(AC)/VIL(AC) at the time of the rising clock transition), a valid input signal is still required to complete the transition and reach VIH(AC)/VIL(AC). For slew rates in between the values listed in Tables 26 and 27, the derating values may obtained by linear interpolation. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 93 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Slew Rate Derating Table 26: DDR2-400/533 Setup and Hold Time Derating Values (tIS and tIH) CK, CK# Differential Slew Rate Command/ Address Slew Rate (V/ns) t Δ IS t Δ IH t Δ IS t Δ IH t Δ IS ΔtIH Units 4.0 3.5 3.0 2.5 2.0 1.5 1.0 0.9 0.8 0.7 0.6 0.5 0.4 0.3 0.25 0.2 0.15 0.1 +187 +179 +167 +150 +125 +83 0 –11 –25 –43 –67 –110 –175 –285 –350 –525 –800 –1,450 +94 +89 +83 +75 +45 +21 0 –14 –31 –54 –83 –125 –188 –292 –375 –500 –708 –1,125 +217 +209 +197 +180 +155 +113 +30 +19 +5 –13 –37 –80 –145 –255 –320 –495 –770 –1,420 +124 +119 +113 +105 +75 +51 +30 +16 –1 –24 –53 –95 –158 –262 –345 –470 –678 –1,095 +247 +239 +227 +210 +185 +143 +60 +49 +35 +17 –7 –50 –115 –225 –290 –465 –740 –1,390 +154 +149 +143 +135 +105 +81 +60 +46 +29 +6 –23 –65 –128 –232 –315 –440 –648 –1,065 ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps Table 27: 2.0 V/ns 1.5 V/ns 1.0 V/ns DDR2-667 Setup and Hold Time Derating Values (tIS and tIH) CK, CK# Differential Slew Rate Command/ Address Slew Rate (V/ns) ΔtIS ΔtIH ΔtIS ΔtIH ΔtIS ΔtIH Units 4.0 3.5 3.0 2.5 2.0 1.5 1.0 0.9 0.8 0.7 0.6 0.5 0.4 0.3 0.25 0.2 0.15 0.1 +150 +143 +133 +120 +100 +67 0 –5 –13 –22 –34 –60 –100 –168 –200 –325 –517 –1,000 +94 +89 +83 +75 +45 +21 0 –14 –31 –54 –83 –125 –188 –292 –375 –500 –708 –1,125 +180 +173 +163 +150 +160 +97 +30 +25 +17 +8 –4 –30 –70 –138 –170 –295 –487 –970 +124 +119 +113 +105 +75 +51 +30 +16 –1 –24 –53 –95 –158 –262 –345 –470 –678 –1,095 +210 +203 +193 +180 +160 +127 +60 +55 +47 +38 +36 0 –40 –108 –140 –265 –457 –940 +154 +149 +143 +135 +105 +81 +60 +46 +29 +6 –23 –65 –128 –232 –315 –440 –648 –1,065 ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps ps 2.0 V/ns PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 1.5 V/ns 94 1.0 V/ns Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Slew Rate Derating Figure 71: Nominal Slew Rate for tIS CK CK# tIH tIS VDDQ tIH tIS VIH(AC) MIN VREF to AC region VIH(DC) MIN Nominal slew rate VREF(DC) Nominal slew rate VIL(DC) MAX VREF to AC region VIL(AC) MAX VSS ΔTF Setup slew rate falling signal PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN = ΔTR VREF(DC) - VIL(AC) MAX ΔTF 95 Setup slew rate rising signal = VIH(AC) MIN - VREF(DC) ΔTR Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Slew Rate Derating Figure 72: Tangent Line for tIS CK CK# tIS tIH tIH tIS VDDQ VIH(AC) MIN VREF to AC region Nominal line VIH(DC) MIN Tangent line VREF(DC) Tangent line VIL(DC) MAX Nominal line VREF to AC region VIL(AC) MAX ΔTF ΔTR VSS Setup slew rate = rising signal PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 96 tangent line [VIH(AC) MIN - VREF(DC)] ΔTR Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Slew Rate Derating Figure 73: Nominal Slew Rate for tIH CK CK# tIS tIS tIH tIH VDDQ VIH(AC) MIN VIH(DC) MIN DC to VREF region Nominal slew rate VREF(DC) Nominal slew rate DC to VREF region VIL(DC) MAX VIL(AC) MAX VSS ΔTR PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 97 ΔTF Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Slew Rate Derating Figure 74: Tangent Line for tIH CK CK# tIS tIS tIH tIH VDDQ VIH(AC) MIN Nominal line VIH(DC) MIN DC to VREF region Tangent line VREF(DC) Tangent line Nominal line DC to VREF region VIL(DC) MAX VIL(AC) MAX VSS ΔTF ΔTR Hold slew rate = rising signal PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN tangent line [VREF(DC) - VIL(DC) MAX] ΔTR 98 Hold slew rate = falling signal tangent line [VIH(DC) MIN - VREF(DC)] ΔTF Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Slew Rate Derating Table 28: DDR2-400/533 tDS, tDH Derating Values with Differential Strobe Notes: 1–7; all units in ps DQS, DQS# Differential Slew Rate DQ Slew 4.0 V/ns 3.0 V/ns 2.0 V/ns 1.8 V/ns 1.6 V/ns 1.4 V/ns 1.2 V/ns 1.0 V/ns 0.8 V/ns Rate t t t t t t t t t t t t t t t t t (V/ns) Δ DS Δ DH Δ DS Δ DH Δ DS Δ DH Δ DS Δ DH Δ DS Δ DH Δ DS Δ DH Δ DS Δ DH Δ DS Δ DH Δ DS ΔtDH 2.0 1.5 1.0 0.9 0.8 0.7 0.6 0.5 0.4 125 83 0 – – – – – – 45 21 0 – – – – – – 125 83 0 –11 – – – – – Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 45 21 0 –14 – – – – – 125 83 0 –11 –25 – – – – 45 21 0 –14 –31 – – – – – 95 12 1 –13 –31 – – – – 33 12 –2 –19 –42 – – – – – 24 13 –1 –19 –43 – – – – 24 10 –7 –30 –59 – – – – – 25 11 –7 –31 –74 – – – – 22 5 –18 –47 –89 – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – 23 17 – – – – 5 –6 17 6 – – –19 –35 –7 –23 5 –11 –62 –77 –50 –65 –38 –53 –127 –140 –115 –128 –103 –116 1. For all input signals, the total tDS and tDH required is calculated by adding the data sheet value to the derating value listed in Table 28. 2. tDS nominal slew rate for a rising signal is defined as the slew rate between the last crossing of VREF(DC) and the first crossing of VIH(AC) MIN. tDS nominal slew rate for a falling signal is defined as the slew rate between the last crossing of VREF(DC) and the first crossing of VIL(AC) MAX. If the actual signal is always earlier than the nominal slew rate line between shaded “VREF(DC) to AC region,” use nominal slew rate for derating value (see Figure 75). If the actual signal is later than the nominal slew rate line anywhere between shaded “VREF(DC) to AC region,” the slew rate of a tangent line to the actual signal from the AC level to DC level is used for derating value (see Figure 76). 3. tDH nominal slew rate for a rising signal is defined as the slew rate between the last crossing of VIL(DC) MAX and the first crossing of VREF(DC). tDH nominal slew rate for a falling signal is defined as the slew rate between the last crossing of VIH(DC) MIN and the first crossing of VREF (DC). If the actual signal is always later than the nominal slew rate line between shaded “DC level to VREF(DC) region,” use nominal slew rate for derating value (see Figure 77). If the actual signal is earlier than the nominal slew rate line anywhere between shaded “DC to VREF(DC) region,” the slew rate of a tangent line to the actual signal from the DC level to VREF(DC) level is used for derating value (see Figure 78). 4. Although the total setup time might be negative for slow slew rates (a valid input signal will not have reached VIH(AC)/VIL(AC) at the time of the rising clock transition), a valid input signal is still required to complete the transition and reach VIH(AC)/VIL(AC). 5. For slew rates between the values listed in this table, the derating values may be obtained by linear interpolation. 6. These values are typically not subject to production test. They are verified by design and characterization. 7. Single-ended DQS requires special derating. The values in Table 30 are the DQS singleended slew rate derating with DQS referenced at VREF and DQ referenced at the logic levels t DSb and tDHb. Table 31 provides the VREF-based fully derated values for the DQ (tDSa and tDH ) for DDR2-667. Table 32 provides the VREF-based fully derated values for the DQ (tDS a a and tDHa) for DDR2-533. Table 33 provides the VREF-based fully derated values for the DQ (tDSa and tDHa) for DDR2-400. 99 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Slew Rate Derating Table 29: DDR2-667 tDS, tDH Derating Values with Differential Strobe Notes: 1–7; all units in ps DQS, DQS# Differential Slew Rate DQ Slew 2.8 V/ns 2.4 V/ns 2.0 V/ns 1.8 V/ns 1.6 V/ns 1.4 V/ns 1.2 V/ns 1.0 V/ns 0.8 V/ns Rate t t t t t t t t t t t t t t t t t (V/ns) Δ DS Δ DH Δ DS Δ DH Δ DS Δ DH Δ DS Δ DH Δ DS Δ DH Δ DS Δ DH Δ DS Δ DH Δ DS Δ DH Δ DS ΔtDH 2.0 1.5 1.0 0.9 0.8 0.7 0.6 0.5 0.4 100 63 100 63 100 63 67 42 67 42 67 42 0 0 0 0 0 0 –5 –14 –5 –14 –5 –14 –13 –31 –13 –31 –13 –31 –22 –54 –22 –54 –22 –54 –34 –83 –34 –83 –34 –83 –60 –125 –60 –125 –60 –125 –100 –188 –100 –188 –100 –188 Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 112 79 12 7 –1 –10 –22 –48 –88 75 54 12 –2 –19 –42 –71 –113 –176 124 91 24 19 11 2 –10 –36 –76 87 66 24 10 –7 –30 –59 –101 –164 136 103 36 31 23 14 2 –24 –64 99 78 36 22 5 –18 –47 –89 –152 148 115 48 43 35 26 14 –12 –52 111 90 48 34 17 –6 –35 –77 –140 160 127 60 55 47 38 26 0 –40 123 102 60 46 29 6 –23 –65 –128 172 139 72 67 59 50 38 12 –28 135 114 72 58 41 18 –11 –53 –116 1. For all input signals the total tDS and tDH required is calculated by adding the data sheet value to the derating value listed in Table 29. 2. tDS nominal slew rate for a rising signal is defined as the slew rate between the last crossing of VREF(DC) and the first crossing of VIH(AC) MIN. tDS nominal slew rate for a falling signal is defined as the slew rate between the last crossing of VREF(DC) and the first crossing of VIL(AC) MAX. If the actual signal is always earlier than the nominal slew rate line between shaded “VREF(DC) to AC region,” use nominal slew rate for derating value (see Figure 75). If the actual signal is later than the nominal slew rate line anywhere between shaded “VREF(DC) to AC region,” the slew rate of a tangent line to the actual signal from the AC level to DC level is used for derating value (see Figure 76). 3. tDH nominal slew rate for a rising signal is defined as the slew rate between the last crossing of VIL(DC) MAX and the first crossing of VREF(DC). tDH nominal slew rate for a falling signal is defined as the slew rate between the last crossing of VIH(DC) MIN and the first crossing of VREF (DC). If the actual signal is always later than the nominal slew rate line between shaded “DC level to VREF(DC) region,” use nominal slew rate for derating value (see Figure 77). If the actual signal is earlier than the nominal slew rate line anywhere between shaded “DC to VREF(DC) region,” the slew rate of a tangent line to the actual signal from the DC level to VREF(DC) level is used for derating value (see Figure 78). 4. Although the total setup time might be negative for slow slew rates (a valid input signal will not have reached VIH(AC)/VIL(AC) at the time of the rising clock transition), a valid input signal is still required to complete the transition and reach VIH(AC)/VIL(AC). 5. For slew rates between the values listed in this table, the derating values may be obtained by linear interpolation. 6. These values are typically not subject to production test. They are verified by design and characterization. 7. Single-ended DQS requires special derating. The values in Table 30 are the DQS singleended slew rate derating with DQS referenced at VREF and DQ referenced at the logic levels t DSb and tDHb. Table 31 provides the VREF-based fully derated values for the DQ (tDSa and tDH ) for DDR2-667. Table 32 provides the VREF-based fully derated values for the DQ (tDS a a and tDHa) for DDR2-533. Table 33 provides the VREF-based fully derated values for the DQ (tDSa and tDHa) for DDR2-400. 100 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Slew Rate Derating Table 30: Single-Ended DQS Slew Rate Derating Values Using tDSb and tDHb Reference points indicated in bold DQS Single-Ended Slew Rate Derated (at VREF) 2.0 V/ns DQ t (V/ns) DS tDH 2 1.5 1 0.9 0.8 0.7 0.6 0.5 0.4 130 97 30 25 17 5 –7 –28 –78 53 32 –10 –24 –41 –64 –93 –135 –198 1.8 V/ns 1.4 V/ns 1.2 V/ns 1.0 V/ns t t t t t t t 130 97 30 25 17 5 –7 –28 –78 53 32 –10 –24 –41 –64 –93 –135 –198 130 97 30 25 17 5 –7 –28 –78 53 32 –10 –24 –41 –64 –93 –135 –198 130 97 30 25 17 5 –7 –28 –78 53 32 –10 –24 –41 –64 –93 –135 –198 130 97 30 25 17 5 –7 –28 –78 53 32 –10 –24 –41 –64 –93 –135 –198 DS DH DS DH DS DH DS DH 0.8 V/ns 0.6 V/ns 0.4V/ns t t t t t t t t 145 112 45 40 32 20 8 –13 –63 48 27 –15 –29 –46 –69 –98 –140 –203 155 122 55 50 42 30 18 –3 –53 45 24 –18 –32 –49 –72 –102 –143 –206 165 132 65 60 52 40 28 7 –43 41 20 –22 –36 –53 –75 –105 –147 –210 175 142 75 70 61 50 38 17 –33 38 17 –25 –39 –56 –79 –108 –150 –213 DS DH DS DH DS DH DS DH 1. Derating values, to be used with base tDSb- and tDHb-specified values. Notes: Table 31: 1.6 V/ns t Single-Ended DQS Slew Rate Fully Derated (DQS, DQ at VREF) at DDR2-667 Reference points indicated in bold DQS Single-Ended Slew Rate Derated (at VREF) 2.0 V/ns DQ t (V/ns) DS tDH 2 1.5 1 0.9 0.8 0.7 0.6 0.5 0.4 330 330 330 347 367 391 426 472 522 291 290 290 290 290 290 290 290 289 1.8 V/ns 1.6 V/ns 1.4 V/ns 1.2 V/ns 1.0 V/ns 0.8 V/ns 0.6 V/ns 0.4V/ns tDS tDH tDS tDH tDS tDH tDS tDH tDS tDH tDS tDH tDS tDH tDS tDH 330 330 330 347 367 391 426 472 522 291 290 290 290 290 290 290 290 289 330 330 330 347 367 391 426 472 522 291 290 290 290 290 290 290 290 289 330 330 330 347 367 391 426 472 522 291 290 290 290 290 290 290 290 289 330 330 330 347 367 391 426 472 522 291 290 290 290 290 290 290 290 289 345 345 345 362 382 406 441 487 537 286 285 285 285 285 285 285 285 284 355 355 355 372 392 416 451 497 547 282 282 282 282 282 281 282 282 281 365 365 365 382 402 426 461 507 557 29 279 278 278 278 278 278 278 278 375 375 375 392 412 436 471 517 567 276 275 275 275 275 275 275 275 274 PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 101 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Slew Rate Derating Table 32: Single-Ended DQS Slew Rate Fully Derated (DQS, DQ at VREF) at DDR2-533 Reference points indicated in bold DQS Single-Ended Slew Rate Derated (at VREF) 2.0 V/ns DQ (V/ns) tDS tDH 2 1.5 1 0.9 0.8 0.7 0.6 0.5 0.4 355 364 380 402 429 463 510 572 647 Table 33: 341 340 340 340 340 340 340 340 339 1.8 V/ns 1.6 V/ns 1.4 V/ns 1.2 V/ns t t t t t t t t 355 364 380 402 429 463 510 572 647 341 340 340 340 340 340 340 340 339 355 364 380 402 429 463 510 572 647 341 340 340 340 340 340 340 340 339 355 364 380 402 429 463 510 572 647 341 340 340 340 340 340 340 340 339 355 364 380 402 429 463 510 572 647 341 340 340 340 340 340 340 340 339 DS DH DS DH DS DH DS DH 1.0 V/ns 0.8 V/ns 0.6 V/ns 0.4V/ns t t t t t t t t 370 379 395 417 444 478 525 587 662 336 335 335 335 335 335 335 335 334 380 389 405 427 454 488 535 597 672 332 332 332 332 332 331 332 332 331 390 399 415 437 464 498 545 607 682 329 329 328 328 328 328 328 328 328 400 409 425 447 474 508 555 617 692 326 325 325 325 325 325 325 325 324 DS DH DS DH DS DH DS DH Single-Ended DQS Slew Rate Fully Derated (DQS, DQ at VREF) at DDR2-400 Reference points indicated in bold DQS Single-Ended Slew Rate Derated (at VREF) 2.0 V/ns DQ t (V/ns) DS tDH 2 1.5 1 0.9 0.8 0.7 0.6 0.5 0.4 405 414 430 452 479 513 560 622 697 391 390 390 390 390 390 390 390 389 1.8 V/ns 1.6 V/ns 1.4 V/ns 1.2 V/ns 1.0 V/ns 0.8 V/ns 0.6 V/ns 0.4V/ns tDS tDH tDS tDH tDS tDH tDS tDH tDS tDH tDS tDH tDS tDH tDS tDH 405 414 430 452 479 513 560 622 697 391 390 390 390 390 390 390 390 389 405 414 430 452 479 513 560 622 697 391 390 390 390 390 390 390 390 389 405 414 430 452 479 513 560 622 697 391 390 390 390 390 390 390 390 389 405 414 430 452 479 513 560 622 697 391 390 390 390 390 390 390 390 389 420 429 445 467 494 528 575 637 712 386 385 385 385 385 385 385 385 384 430 439 455 477 504 538 585 647 722 382 382 382 382 382 381 382 382 381 440 449 465 487 514 548 595 657 732 379 379 378 378 378 378 378 378 378 450 459 475 497 524 558 605 667 742 376 375 375 375 375 375 375 375 374 PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 102 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Slew Rate Derating Figure 75: Nominal Slew Rate for tDS DQS1 DQS#1 t DS t t DH t DS DH VDDQ VIH(AC) MIN VREF to AC region VIH(DC) MIN Nominal slew rate VREF(DC) Nominal slew rate VIL(DC) MAX VREF to AC region VIL(AC) MAX VSS ΔTF Setup slew rate = falling signal Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN ΔTR VREF(DC) - VIL(AC) MAX ΔTF Setup slew rate = rising signal VIH(AC) MIN - VREF(DC) ΔTR 1. DQS, DQS# signals must be monotonic between VIL(DC) MAX and VIH(DC) MIN. 103 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Slew Rate Derating Figure 76: Tangent Line for tDS DQS1 DQS#1 t t t DS DS DH VDDQ VIH(AC) MIN t DH Nominal line VREF to AC region VIH(DC) MIN Tangent line VREF(DC) Tangent line VIL(DC) MAX Nominal line VREF to AC region VIL(AC) MAX ΔTR ΔTF VSS Setup Slew Rate tangent line [VREF(DC) - VIL(AC) MAX] Falling Signal = ΔTF Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Setup Slew Rate tangent line [VIH(AC) MIN - VREF(DC)] Rising Signal = ΔTR 1. DQS, DQS# signals must be monotonic between VIL(DC) MAX and VIH(DC) MIN. 104 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Slew Rate Derating Figure 77: Nominal Slew Rate for tDH DQS1 DQS#1 tIS tIS tIH tIH VDDQ VIH(AC) MIN VIH(DC) MIN DC to VREF region Nominal slew rate VREF(DC) Nominal slew rate DC to VREF region VIL(DC) MAX VIL(AC) MAX VSS ΔTR Hold slew rate VREF(DC) - VIL(DC) MAX rising signal = ΔTR Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN ΔTF Hold slew rate VIH(DC) MIN - VREF(DC) falling signal = ΔTF 1. DQS, DQS# signals must be monotonic between VIL(DC) MAX and VIH(DC) MIN. 105 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Slew Rate Derating Figure 78: Tangent Line for tDH DQS1 DQS#1 tIS tIS tIH tIH VDDQ VIH(AC) MIN Nominal line VIH(DC) MIN DC to VREF region Tangent line VREF(DC) Tangent line Nominal line DC to VREF region VIL(DC) MAX VIL(AC) MAX VSS ΔTF ΔTR Hold Slew Rate = Rising Signal Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN tangent line [VREF(DC) - VIL(DC) MAX] ΔTR Hold Slew Rate Falling Signal = tangent line [VIH(DC) MIN - VREF(DC)] ΔTF 1. DQS, DQS# signals must be monotonic between VIL(DC) MAX and VIH(DC) MIN. 106 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Slew Rate Derating Figure 79: AC Input Test Signal Waveform Command/Address Balls CK# CK tIS b tIS b tIH b tIH b Logic Levels VDDQ VSWING (MAX) VIH(AC) MIN VIH(DC) MIN VREF(DC) VIL(DC) MAX VIL(AC) MAX VSSQ VREF Levels Figure 80: tIS a tIS a tIH a tIH a AC Input Test Signal Waveform for Data with DQS, DQS# (Differential) DQS# DQS tDS b tDH b tDS b tDH b Logic Levels VDDQ VSWING (MAX) VIH(AC) MIN VIH(DC) MIN VREF(DC) VIL(DC) MAX VIL(AC) MAX VSSQ VREF Levels PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN tDS a 107 tDH a tDS a tDH a Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Input Slew Rate Derating Figure 81: AC Input Test Signal Waveform for Data with DQS (single-ended) VREF DQS tDS b Logic Levels tDH b tDS b tDH b VDDQ VSWING (MAX) VIH(AC) MIN VIH(DC) MIN VREF(DC) VIL(DC) MAX VIL(AC) MAX VSSQ VREF Levels tDS a Figure 82: tDH a tDS a tDH a AC Input Test Signal Waveform (differential) VDDQ VTR Crossing Point VSWING VIX VCP VSSQ PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 108 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Power and Ground Clamp Characteristics Power and Ground Clamp Characteristics Power and ground clamps are provided on the following input-only balls: BA2–BA0, A0– A13 ( x4, x8), A0–A12 (x16), CS#, RAS#, CAS#, WE#, ODT, and CKE. Table 34: Figure 83: Input Clamp Characteristics Voltage Across Clamp (V) Minimum Power Clamp Current (mA) Minimum Ground Clamp Current (mA) 0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 1.8 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.1 1.0 2.5 4.7 6.8 9.1 11.0 13.5 16.0 18.2 21.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.1 1.0 2.5 4.7 6.8 9.1 11.0 13.5 16.0 18.2 21.0 Input Clamp Characteristics Minimum Clamp Current (mA) 25.0 20.0 15.0 10.0 5.0 0.0 0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 1.8 Voltage Across Clamp (V) PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 109 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM AC Overshoot/Undershoot Specification AC Overshoot/Undershoot Specification Some revisions will support the 0.9V maximum average amplitude instead of the 0.5V maximum average amplitude that is shown in Table 35 and Table 36. Table 35: Address and Control Balls Applies to BA2–BA0, A0–A13 ( x4, x8), A0–A12 (x16), CS#, RAS#, CAS#, WE#, CKE, ODT Specification Parameter Maximum peak amplitude allowed for overshoot area (see Figure 84) Maximum peak amplitude allowed for undershoot area (see Figure 85) Maximum overshoot area above VDD (see Figure 84) Maximum undershoot area below VSS (see Figure 85) Table 36: -5E -37E -3/-3E -25/-25E 0.50V 0.50V 1.33 Vns 1.33 Vns 0.50V 0.50V 1.00 Vns 1.00 Vns 0.50V 0.50V 0.80 Vns 0.80 Vns 0.50V 0.50V 0.66 Vns 0.66 Vns Clock, Data, Strobe, and Mask Balls Applies to DQ, DQS, DQS#, RDQS, RDQS#, UDQS, UDQS#, LDQS, LDQS#, DM, UDM, LDM Specification Parameter Maximum peak amplitude allowed for overshoot area (see Figure 84) Maximum peak amplitude allowed for undershoot area (see Figure 85) Maximum overshoot area above VDDQ (see Figure 84) Maximum undershoot area below VSSQ (see Figure 85) -37E -3/-3E -25/-25E 0.50V 0.50V 0.28 Vns 0.28 Vns 0.50V 0.50V 0.23 Vns 0.23 Vns 0.50V 0.50V 0.19 Vns 0.19 Vns Overshoot Volts (V) Figure 84: -5E 0.50V 0.50V 0.38 Vns 0.38 Vns Maximum Amplitude Overshoot Area VDD/VDDQ VSS/VSSQ Time (ns) Figure 85: Undershoot Volts (V) VSS/VSSQ Undershoot Area Maximum Amplitude Time (ns) PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 110 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Output Electrical Characteristics and Operating Conditions Output Electrical Characteristics and Operating Conditions Table 37: Differential AC Output Parameters Parameter Symbol Min Max Units Notes AC differential cross-point voltage AC differential voltage swing VOX(AC) VSWING 0.50 x VDDQ - 125 1.0 0.50 x VDDQ + 125 mV mV 1 Notes: Figure 86: 1. The typical value of VOX(AC) is expected to be about 0.5 x VDDQ of the transmitting device and VOX(AC) is expected to track variations in VDDQ. VOX(AC) indicates the voltage at which differential output signals must cross. Differential Output Signal Levels VDDQ VTR Crossing Point VSWING VOX VCP VSSQ PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 111 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Output Electrical Characteristics and Operating Conditions Table 38: Output DC Current Drive Parameter Output minimum source DC current Output minimum sink DC current Notes: Table 39: Value Units Notes IOH IOL –13.4 13.4 mA mA 1, 2, 4 2, 3, 4 1. For IOH(DC); VDDQ = 1.7V, VOUT = 1,420mV. (VOUT - VDDQ)/IOH must be less than 21Ω for values of VOUT between VDDQ and VDDQ - 280mV. 2. For IOL(DC); VDDQ = 1.7V, VOUT = 280mV. VOUT/IOL must be less than 21Ω for values of VOUT between 0V and 280mV. 3. The DC value of VREF applied to the receiving device is set to VTT. 4. The values of IOH(DC) and IOL(DC) are based on the conditions given in Notes 1 and 2. They are used to test device drive current capability to ensure VIH (MIN) plus a noise margin and VIL (MAX) minus a noise margin are delivered to an SSTL_18 receiver. The actual current values are derived by shifting the desired driver operating point (see output IV curves) along a 21Ω load line to define a convenient driver current for measurement. Output Characteristics Parameter Output impedance Pull-up and pull-down mismatch Output slew rate Notes: Figure 87: Symbol Min Nom Max See “Full Strength Pull-Down Driver Characteristics” on page 113 0 4 1.5 5 Units Notes Ω 1, 2 Ω 1, 2, 3 V/ns 1, 4, 5, 6 1. Absolute specifications: 0°C ≤ TC ≤ +85°C; VDDQ = +1.8V ±0.1V, VDD = +1.8V ±0.1V. 2. Impedance measurement conditions for output source DC current: VDDQ = 1.7V; VOUT = 1,420mV; (VOUT - VDDQ)/IOH must be less than 23.4Ω for values of VOUT between VDDQ and VDDQ - 280mV. Impedance measurement condition for output sink DC current: VDDQ = 1.7V; VOUT = 280mV; VOUT/IOL must be less than 23.4Ω for values of VOUT between 0V and 280mV. 3. Mismatch is absolute value between pull-up and pull-down; both are measured at same temperature and voltage. 4. Output slew rate for falling and rising edges is measured between VTT - 250mV and VTT + 250mV for single-ended signals. For differential signals (DQS - DQS#), output slew rate is measured between DQS - DQS# = –500mV and DQS# - DQS = +500mV. Output slew rate is guaranteed by design, but is not necessarily tested on each device. 5. The absolute value of the slew rate as measured from VIL(DC) MAX to VIH(DC) MIN is equal to or greater than the slew rate as measured from VIL(AC) MAX to VIH(AC) MIN. This is guaranteed by design and characterization. 6. IT devices require an additional 0.4 V/ns in the MAX limit when TC is between –40°C and 0°C. Output Slew Rate Load VTT = VDDQ/2 Output (VOUT) PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 25Ω Reference Point 112 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Full Strength Pull-Down Driver Characteristics Full Strength Pull-Down Driver Characteristics Figure 88: Full Strength Pull-Down Characteristics Pull-down Characteristics 120.00 I OUT (mA) 100.00 80.00 60.00 40.00 20.00 0.00 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 V OUT(V) Table 40: Full Strength Pull-Down Current (mA) PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Voltage (V) Minimum Nominal Maximum 0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 1.8 1.9 0.00 4.3 8.6 12.9 16.9 20.4 23.28 25.44 26.79 27.67 28.38 28.96 29.46 29.90 30.29 30.65 30.98 31.31 31.64 31.96 0.00 5.63 11.3 16.52 22.19 27.59 32.39 36.45 40.38 44.01 47.01 49.63 51.71 53.32 54.9 56.03 57.07 58.16 59.27 60.35 0.00 7.95 15.90 23.85 31.80 39.75 47.70 55.55 62.95 69.55 75.35 80.35 84.55 87.95 90.70 93.00 95.05 97.05 99.05 101.05 113 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Full Strength Pull-Up Driver Characteristics Full Strength Pull-Up Driver Characteristics Figure 89: Full Strength Pull-Up Characteristics Pull-up Characteristics 0.0 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 -20.0 I OUT (mA) -40.0 -60.0 -80.0 -100.0 -120.0 V DDQ - VOUT (V) Table 41: Full Strength Pull-Up Current (mA) PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Voltage (V) Minimum Nominal Maximum 0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 1.8 1.9 0.00 –4.3 –8.6 –12.9 –16.9 –20.4 –23.28 –25.44 –26.79 –27.67 –28.38 –28.96 –29.46 –29.90 –30.29 –30.65 –30.98 –31.31 –31.64 –31.96 0.00 –5.63 –11.3 –16.52 –22.19 –27.59 –32.39 –36.45 –40.38 –44.01 –47.01 –49.63 –51.71 –53.32 –54.90 –56.03 –57.07 –58.16 –59.27 –60.35 0.00 –7.95 –15.90 –23.85 –31.80 –39.75 –47.70 –55.55 –62.95 –69.55 –75.35 –80.35 –84.55 –87.95 –90.70 –93.00 –95.05 –97.05 –99.05 –101.05 114 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Reduced Strength Pull-Down Driver Characteristics Reduced Strength Pull-Down Driver Characteristics Figure 90: Reduced Strength Pull-Down Characteristics Pull-down Characteristics 70.00 60.00 I OUT (mA) 50.00 40.00 30.00 20.00 10.00 0.00 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 VOUT (V) Table 42: Reduced Strength Pull-Down Current (mA) PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Voltage (V) Minimum Nominal Maximum 0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 1.8 1.9 0.00 1.72 3.44 5.16 6.76 8.16 9.31 10.18 10.72 11.07 11.35 11.58 11.78 11.96 12.12 12.26 12.39 12.52 12.66 12.78 0.00 2.98 5.99 8.75 11.76 14.62 17.17 19.32 21.40 23.32 24.92 26.30 27.41 28.26 29.10 29.70 30.25 30.82 31.41 31.98 0.00 4.77 9.54 14.31 19.08 23.85 28.62 33.33 37.77 41.73 45.21 48.21 50.73 52.77 54.42 55.80 57.03 58.23 59.43 60.63 115 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Reduced Strength Pull-Up Driver Characteristics Reduced Strength Pull-Up Driver Characteristics Figure 91: Reduced Strength Pull-Up Characteristics Pull-up Characteristics 0.0 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 -10.0 I OUT (mA) -20.0 -30.0 -40.0 -50.0 -60.0 -70.0 VDDQ - VOUT (V) Table 43: Reduced Strength Pull-Up Current (mA) PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Voltage (V) Minimum Nominal Maximum 0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 1.8 1.9 0.00 –1.72 –3.44 –5.16 –6.76 –8.16 –9.31 –10.18 –10.72 –11.07 –11.35 –11.58 –11.78 –11.96 –12.12 –12.26 –12.39 –12.52 –12.66 –12.78 0.00 –2.98 –5.99 –8.75 –11.76 –14.62 –17.17 –19.32 –21.40 –23.32 –24.92 –26.30 –27.41 –28.26 –29.10 –29.69 –30.25 –30.82 –31.42 –31.98 0.00 –4.77 –9.54 –14.31 –19.08 –23.85 –28.62 –33.33 –37.77 –41.73 –45.21 –48.21 –50.73 –52.77 –54.42 –55.8 –57.03 –58.23 –59.43 –60.63 116 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM FBGA Package Capacitance FBGA Package Capacitance Table 44: Input Capacitance Parameter Input capacitance: CK, CK# Delta input capacitance: CK, CK# Input capacitance: BA2–BA0, A0–A13 (A0–A12 on x16), CS#, RAS#, CAS#, WE#, CKE, ODT Delta input capacitance: BA2–BA0, A0–A13 (A0–A12 on x16), CS#, RAS#, CAS#, WE#, CKE, ODT Input/Output capacitance: DQs, DQS, DM, NF Delta input/output capacitance: DQs, DQS, DM, NF Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN Symbol Min Max Units Notes CCK CDCK CI 1.0 – 1.0 2.0 0.25 2.0 pF pF pF 1 2 1 CDI – 0.25 pF 2 CIO CDIO 2.5 – 4.0 0.5 pF pF 1, 4 3 1. This parameter is sampled. VDD = +1.8V ±0.1V, VDDQ = +1.8V ±0.1V, VREF = VSS, f = 100 MHz, TC = 25°C, VOUT(DC) = VDDQ/2, VOUT (peak-to-peak) = 0.1V. DM input is grouped with I/O balls, reflecting the fact that they are matched in loading. 2. The input capacitance per ball group will not differ by more than this maximum amount for any given device. 3. The I/O capacitance per DQS and DQ byte/group will not differ by more than this maximum amount for any given device. 4. Reduce MAX limit by 0.5pF for -3/-3E/-25/-25E speed devices. 5. Reduce MAX limit by 0.25pF for -3/-3E/-25/-25E speed devices. 117 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM IDD Specifications and Conditions IDD Specifications and Conditions Table 45: DDR2 IDD Specifications and Conditions (continued) Notes: 1–7; notes appear on page 119 Parameter/Condition Sym Config -25E -25 100 100 90 80 70 150 150 135 110 110 110 110 100 95 80 x16 175 175 130 120 115 x4, x8, x16 7 7 7 7 7 65 65 55 41 35 75 75 65 45 40 70 70 60 45 40 80 80 70 50 40 45 45 40 30 25 10 10 10 10 10 75 75 70 55 45 x16 85 85 75 60 55 x4, x8 185 185 160 130 110 tCK Operating one bank active-precharge current: = t CK (IDD), tRC = tRC (IDD), tRAS = tRAS MIN (IDD); CKE is IDD0 HIGH, CS# is HIGH between valid commands; Address bus inputs are switching; Data bus inputs are switching Operating one bank active-read-precharge current: IOUT = 0mA; BL = 4, CL = CL (IDD), AL = 0; tCK = tCK (IDD), t RC = tRC (Idd), tRAS = tRAS MIN (IDD), tRCD = tRCD (IDD); IDD1 CKE is HIGH, CS# is HIGH between valid commands; Address bus inputs are switching; Data pattern is same as IDD4W Precharge power-down current: All banks idle; tCK = tCK (IDD); CKE is LOW; Other control and address bus IDD2P inputs are stable; Data bus inputs are floating Precharge quiet standby current: All banks idle; tCK = tCK (IDD); CKE is HIGH, CS# is HIGH; Other control and IDD2Q address bus inputs are stable; Data bus inputs are floating Precharge standby current: All banks idle; tCK = tCK (IDD); CKE is HIGH, CS# is HIGH; Other control and address IDD2N bus inputs are switching; Data bus inputs are switching Active power-down current: All banks open; tCK = tCK (IDD); CKE is LOW; Other control and address bus inputs are stable; Data bus inputs are floating IDD3P Active standby current: All banks open; tCK = tCK (IDD), tRAS = tRAS MAX (IDD), tRP = tRP (IDD); CKE is HIGH, CS# is HIGH between valid commands; Other control and IDD3N address bus inputs are switching; Data bus inputs are switching Operating burst write current: All banks open, continuous burst writes; BL = 4, CL = CL (IDD), AL = 0; tCK = tCK (IDD), tRAS = tRAS MAX (IDD), tRP = tRP (IDD); CKE is IDD4W HIGH, CS# is HIGH between valid commands; Address bus inputs are switching; Data bus inputs are switching Operating burst read current: All banks open, continuous burst reads, IOUT = 0mA; BL = 4, CL = CL (IDD), AL = 0; tCK = tCK (IDD), tRAS = tRAS MAX (IDD), tRP = tRP IDD4R (IDD); CKE is HIGH, CS# is HIGH between valid commands; Address bus inputs are switching; Data bus inputs are switching Burst refresh current: tCK = tCK (IDD); refresh command at every tRFC (IDD) interval; CKE is HIGH, CS# is IDD5 HIGH between valid commands; Other control and address bus inputs are switching; Data bus inputs are switching IDD6 Self refresh current: CK and CK# at 0V; CKE ≤ 0.2V; Other control and address bus inputs are floating; Data IDD6L bus inputs are floating PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 118 x4, x8 x16 x4, x8 -3E/-3 -37E -5E Units mA mA x4, x8 x16 x4, x8 x16 Fast PDN exit MR[12] = 0 Slow PDN exit MR[12] = 1 x4, x8 mA mA mA mA mA mA x16 315 315 200 180 160 x4, x8 190 190 160 145 110 mA x16 x4, x8 320 320 220 180 160 280 280 260 250 220 280 280 270 250 240 7 7 7 7 7 3 3 3 3 3 mA x16 x4, x8, x16 mA Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM IDD Specifications and Conditions Table 45: DDR2 IDD Specifications and Conditions (continued) Notes: 1–7; notes appear on page 119 Parameter/Condition Sym Operating bank interleave read current: All bank interleaving reads, IOUT = 0mA; BL = 4, CL = CL (IDD), AL = t RCD (IDD) - 1 x tCK (IDD); tCK = tCK (IDD), tRC = tRC (IDD), tRRD = tRRD (IDD), tRCD = tRCD (IDD); CKE is HIGH, CS# is HIGH between valid commands; Address bus inputs are stable during deselects; Data bus inputs are switching (see Table 47 on page 120 for details) Notes: Config -25E -25 x4, x8 335 335 -3E/-3 -37E 300 290 -5E Units 260 IDD7 mA x16 440 430 350 330 300 1. IDD specifications are tested after the device is properly initialized. 0°C ≤ TC ≤ +85°C. VDD = +1.8V ±0.1V, VDDQ = +1.8V ±0.1V, VDDL = +1.8V ±0.1V, VREF = VDDQ/2. –37V VDDQ = +1.9V ±0.1V, VDDL = +1.9V ±0.1. 2. Input slew rate is specified by AC parametric test conditions (Table 46 on page 120). 3. IDD parameters are specified with ODT disabled. 4. Data bus consists of DQ, DM, DQS, DQS#, RDQS, RDQS#, LDQS, LDQS#, UDQS, and UDQS#. IDD values must be met with all combinations of EMR bits 10 and 11. 5. Definitions for IDD conditions: LOW HIGH Stable Floating Switching Switching VIN ≤ VIL(AC) MAX VIN ≥ VIH(AC) MIN Inputs stable at a HIGH or LOW level Inputs at VREF = VDDQ/2 Inputs changing between HIGH and LOW every other clock cycle (once per two clocks) for address and control signals Inputs changing between HIGH and LOW every other data transfer (once per clock) for DQ signals, not including masks or strobes 6. IDD1, IDD4R, and IDD7 require A12 in EMR1 to be enabled during testing. 7. The following IDDs must be derated (IDD limits increase) on IT-option devices when operated outside of the range 0°C ≤ TC ≤ 85°C: When TC ≤ 0°C When TC ≥ 85°C PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN IDD2P and IDD3P (slow) must be derated by 4 percent; IDD4R and IDD5W must be derated by 2 percent; and IDD6 and IDD7 must be derated by 7 percent IDD0, IDD1, IDD2N, IDD2Q, IDD3N, IDD3P (fast), IDD4R, IDD4W, and IDD5W must be derated by 2 percent; IDD2P must be derated by 20 percent; IDD3Pslow must be derated by 30 percent; and IDD6 must be derated by 80 percent (IDD6 will increase by this amount if TC < 85°C and the 2x refresh option is still enabled) 119 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM IDD7 Conditions Table 46: General IDD Parameters IDD Parameter CL (IDD) t RCD (IDD) t RC (IDD) tRRD (IDD) - x4/x8 (1KB) t RRD (IDD) - x16 (2KB) t CK (IDD) t RAS MIN (IDD) t RAS MAX (IDD) tRP (IDD) t RFC (IDD) tFAW (1KB) (IDD) tFAW (2KB) (IDD) -25E -25 -3E -3 -37E -5E 5 12.5 57.5 7.5 10 2.5 45 70,000 12.5 127.5 35 45 6 15 60 7.5 10 2.5 45 70,000 15 127.5 35 45 4 12 57 7.5 10 3 45 70,000 12 127.5 37.5 50 5 15 60 7.5 10 3 45 70,000 15 127.5 37.5 50 4 15 60 7.5 10 3.75 45 70,000 15 127.5 37.5 50 3 15 55 7.5 10 5 40 70,000 15 127.5 37.5 50 Units t CK ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns IDD7 Conditions The detailed timings are shown below for IDD7. Changes will be required if timing parameter changes are made to the specification. Where general IDD parameters in Table 46 on page 120 conflict with pattern requirements of Table 47, then Table 47 requirements take precedence. Table 47: IDD7 Timing Patterns (8-bank) All bank interleave READ operation Speed Grade IDD7 Timing Patterns for x4/x8/x16 Timing Patterns for 8-bank devices x4/x8 -5E A0 RA0 A1 RA1 A2 RA2 A3 RA3 A4 RA4 A5 RA5 A6 RA6 A7 RA7 -37E A0 RA0 A1 RA1 A2 RA2 A3 RA3 D D A4 RA4 A5 RA5 A6 RA6 A7 RA7 D D -3 A0 RA0 D A1 RA1 D A2 RA2 D A3 RA3 D D A4 RA4 D A5 RA5 D A6 RA6 D A7 RA7 D D -3E A0 RA0 D A1 RA1 D A2 RA2 D A3 RA3 D D A4 RA4 D A5 RA5 D A6 RA6 D A7 RA7 D D -25 A0 RA0 D A1 RA1 D A2 RA2 D A3 RA3 D D D A4 RA4 D A5 RA5 D A6 RA6 D A7 RA7 D D D -25E A0 RA0 D A1 RA1 D A2 RA2 D A3 RA3 D D D A4 RA4 D A5 RA5 D A6 RA6 D A7 RA7 D D D Timing Patterns for 8-bank devices x16 -5E A0 RA0 A1 RA1 A2 RA2 A3 RA3 D D A4 RA4 A5 RA5 A6 RA6 A7 RA7 D D -37E A0 RA0 D A1 RA1 D A2 RA2 D A3 RA3 D D D A4 RA4 D A5 RA5 D A6 RA6 D A7 RA7 D D D -3 A0 RA0 D D A1 RA1 D D A2 RA2 D D A3 RA3 D D D A4 RA4 D D A5 RA5 D D A6 RA6 D D A7 RA7 D D D -3E A0 RA0 D D A1 RA1 D D A2 RA2 D D A3 RA3 D D D A4 RA4 D D A5 RA5 D D A6 RA6 D D A7 RA7 D D D -25 A0 RA0 D D A1 RA1 D D A2 RA2 D D A3 RA3 D D D D A4 RA4 D D A5 RA5 D D A6 RA6 D D A7 RA7 D D D D -25E A0 RA0 D D A1 RA1 D D A2 RA2 D D A3 RA3 D D D D A4 RA4 D D A5 RA5 D D A6 RA6 D D A7 RA7 D D D D Notes: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 1. A = active; RA = read auto precharge; D = deselect. 2. All banks are being interleaved at minimum tRC (IDD) without violating tRRD (IDD) using a BL = 4. 3. Control and address bus inputs are STABLE during DESELECTs. 4. IOUT = 0mA. 120 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM AC Operating Specifications AC Operating Specifications Table 48: AC Operating Conditions for -3E, -3, -37E, and -5E Speeds (Sheet 1 of 6) Notes: 1–5; notes appear on page 131; VDDQ = +1.8V ±0.1V, VDD = +1.8V ±0.1V AC Characteristics Parameter -3E Symbol CL = 5 tCKAVG(5) CL = 4 tCKAVG(4) CL = 3 tCKAVG(3) CK high-level width tCHAVG tCL CK low-level width AVG tHP Half clock period Clock Jitter Clock (absolute) Clock Clock cycle time Absolute tCK tCK abs Absolute CK highlevel width tCH Absolute CK lowlevel width tCL abs Clock jitter – period Clock jitter – half period Clock jitter – cycle to cycle Cumulative jitter error, 2 cycles Cumulative jitter error, 3 cycles Cumulative jitter error, 4 cycles Cumulative jitter error, 5 cycles Cumulative jitter error, 6–10 cycles Cumulative jitter error, 11–50 cycles abs tJIT PER tJIT DUTY Min Max -37E Min Max Min -5E Max Min Max 3,000 8,000 3,000 8,000 – – – – 3,000 8,000 3,750 8,000 3,750 8,000 5,000 8,000 – – 5,000 8,000 5,000 8,000 5,000 8,000 0.48 0.52 0.48 0.52 0.48 0.52 0.48 0.52 0.48 0.52 0.48 0.52 0.48 0.52 0.48 0.52 MIN MIN MIN MIN (tCH, (tCH, (tCH, (tCH, t t t t CL) CL) CL) CL) t t t t t t t tCK CK CK CK CK CK CK AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG( AVG( AVG( CKAVG (MIN) + (MAX) + MIN) + (MAX) + MIN) + MAX) + MIN) + (MAX) + tJIT tJIT tJIT tJIT tJIT tJIT tJIT tJIT PER PER PER PER PER PER PER PER (MIN) tCK AVG t (MAX) (MIN) (MAX) (MIN) (MAX) (MIN) (MIN) tCK AVG (MAX) tCK AVG (MIN) tCK AVG (MAX) tCK AVG (MIN) tCK AVG (MAX) tCK AVG (MIN) tCK AVG (MAX) tCK AVG (MIN) * tCL AVG (MAX) * tCL AVG (MIN) * tCL AVG (MAX) * tCL AVG (MIN) * tCL AVG (MAX) * tCL AVG (MIN) * tCL AVG (MAX) * tCL AVG (MIN) + tJIT DTY (MAX) + tJIT DTY (MIN) + tJIT DTY (MAX) + tJIT DTY (MIN) + tJIT DTY (MAX) + tJIT DTY (MIN) + tJIT DTY (MAX) + tJIT DTY (MIN) (MAX) (MIN) (MAX) (MIN) (MAX) (MIN) (MAX) –125 –125 125 125 –125 –125 125 125 –125 –125 125 125 –125 –150 125 150 JITCC 250 250 250 Units Notes ps ps ps t CK tCK ps 16, 22, 36, 38 45 46 ps (MAX) CKAVG tCKAVG tCKAVG tCKAVG tCKAVG tCKAVG tCKAVG * (MIN) (MAX) * (MIN)* (MAX) * (MIN) * (MAX) * (MIN)* (MAX) * tCH tCH tCH tCH tCH tCH tCH tCH AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG (MIN) + (MAX) + (MIN)+ (MAX) + (MIN) + (MAX) + (MIN)+ (MAX) + tJIT tJIT tJIT tJIT tJIT tJIT tJIT tJIT DTY DTY DTY DTY DTY DTY DTY DTY t tERR -3 250 ps ps ps ps 39 40 ps 41 2per –175 175 –175 175 –175 175 –175 175 ps 42 ERR3per –225 225 –225 225 –225 225 –225 225 ps 42 4per –250 250 –250 250 –250 250 –250 250 ps 42 ERR5per –250 250 –250 250 –250 250 –250 250 ps 42, 48 tERR 6- –350 350 –350 350 –350 350 –350 350 ps 42, 48 –450 450 –450 450 –450 450 –450 450 ps 42 t tERR t 10per tERR PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 11- 50per 121 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM AC Operating Specifications Table 48: AC Operating Conditions for -3E, -3, -37E, and -5E Speeds (Sheet 2 of 6) Notes: 1–5; notes appear on page 131; VDDQ = +1.8V ±0.1V, VDD = +1.8V ±0.1V AC Characteristics Parameter -3E Symbol Data DQ output access time from CK/CK# Data-out High-Z window from CK/ CK# DQS Low-Z window from CK/CK# DQ Low-Z window from CK/CK# DQ and DM input setup time relative to DQS DQ and DM input hold time relative to DQS DQ and DM input setup time relative to DQS DQ and DM input hold time relative to DQS DQ and DM input pulse width (for each input) Data hold skew factor DQ–DQS hold, DQS to first DQ to go nonvalid, per access Data valid output window (DVW) AC LZ1 tLZ 2 Units Notes Min Max Min Max Min Max – 340 – 340 – 400 – 450 ps 47 –450 +450 –450 +450 –500 +500 –600 +600 ps 34, 43 ps 8, 9, 43 t t AC (MAX) tHZ t -5E Max QHS t -37E Min t DQ hold skew factor -3 tAC (MIN) 2 * tAC (MIN) t AC (MAX) tAC (MAX) t AC (MAX) t AC (MIN) 2 * tAC (MIN) t AC (MAX) tAC (MAX) t AC (MAX) t AC (MIN) 2 * tAC (MIN) t AC (MAX) tAC (MAX) AC (MAX) t AC (MIN) 2 * tAC (MIN) t AC (MAX) tAC (MAX) ps ps 8, 10, 43 8, 10, 43 tDS a 300 300 350 400 ps 7, 15, 19 tDH a 300 300 350 400 ps 7, 15, 19 tDS b 100 100 100 150 ps 7, 15, 19 tDH b 175 175 225 275 ps 7, 15, 19 tDIPW 0.35 0.35 0.35 0.35 tCK 37 ps 47 ps 15, 17, 47 ns 15, 17 tQHS tQH tDVW PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 340 tHP - tQHS t QH - tDQSQ 340 tHP - tQHS t QH - tDQSQ 122 400 tHP - tQHS t QH - tDQSQ 450 tHP - tQHS t QH - tDQSQ Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM AC Operating Specifications Table 48: AC Operating Conditions for -3E, -3, -37E, and -5E Speeds (Sheet 3 of 6) Notes: 1–5; notes appear on page 131; VDDQ = +1.8V ±0.1V, VDD = +1.8V ±0.1V AC Characteristics Data Strobe Parameter -3E Symbol DQS input-high pulse t DQSH width DQS input-low pulse t DQSL width DQS output access t DQSCK time from CK/CK# DQS falling edge to tDSS CK rising – setup time DQS falling edge from CK rising – hold tDSH time DQS–DQ skew, DQS to last DQ valid, per tDQSQ group, per access DQS read preamble tRPRE Min -3 Max Min -37E Max Min -5E Max Min Max Units Notes 0.35 0.35 0.35 0.35 t CK 37 0.35 0.35 0.35 0.35 tCK 37 ps 34, 43 –400 +400 –400 +400 –450 +450 –500 +500 0.2 0.2 0.2 0.2 tCK 37 0.2 0.2 0.2 0.2 tCK 37 350 ps 15, 17 33, 34, 37, 43 33, 34, 37, 43 240 240 300 0.9 1.1 0.9 1.1 0.9 1.1 0.9 1.1 tCK 0.6 0.4 0.6 0.4 0.6 0.4 0.6 tCK DQS read postamble tRPST 0.4 Write preamble setup time DQS write preamble DQS write postamble Positive DQS latching edge to associated clock edge WRITE command to first DQS latching transition tWPRES 0 0 0 0 ps 12, 13 tWPRE 0.35 0.4 0.6 0.35 0.4 0.6 0.25 0.4 0.6 0.25 0.4 tCK tWPST 0.6 tCK 37 11, 37 tDQSS –0.25 0.25 –0.25 0.25 –0.25 0.25 –0.25 0.25 tCK 37 tCK PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN WL - WL + WL - WL + WL - WL + WL - WL + tDQSS tDQSS tDQSS tDQSS tDQSS tDQSS tDQSS tDQSS 123 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM AC Operating Specifications Table 48: AC Operating Conditions for -3E, -3, -37E, and -5E Speeds (Sheet 4 of 6) Notes: 1–5; notes appear on page 131; VDDQ = +1.8V ±0.1V, VDD = +1.8V ±0.1V AC Characteristics Command and Address Parameter Symbol Address and control t IPW input pulse width for each input Address and control tIS a input setup time Address and control t IHa input hold time Address and control tIS b input setup time Address and control t IHb input hold time CAS# to CAS# tCCD command delay ACTIVE-to-ACTIVE tRC (same bank) command tRRD ACTIVE bank a to (x4, x8) ACTIVE bank b tRRD command (x16) ACTIVE-to-READ or tRCD WRITE delay tFAW 4-Bank activate (x4, x8) period tFAW 4-Bank activate (x16) period ACTIVE-totRAS PRECHARGE command Internal READ-tot RTP PRECHARGE command delay tWR Write recovery time Auto precharge t DAL write recovery + precharge time Internal WRITE-tot WTR READ command delay PRECHARGE tRP command period PRECHARGE ALL tRPA command period LOAD MODE tMRD command cycle time PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN -3E Min -3 Max Min -37E Max Min Max -5E Min 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 400 400 500 400 400 200 Max Units Notes t CK 37 600 ps 6, 19 500 600 ps 6, 19 200 250 350 ps 6, 19 275 275 375 475 ps 6, 19 2 2 2 2 tCK 37 54 55 55 55 ns 31, 37 7.5 7.5 7.5 7.5 ns 25, 37 10 10 10 10 ns 25, 37 12 15 15 15 ns 37 37.5 37.5 37.5 37.5 ns 28, 37 50 50 50 50 ns 28, 37 ns 18, 31, 37 7.5 ns 21, 25, 37 ns 25, 37 ns 20 40 70,000 7.5 40 70,000 7.5 40 70,000 7.5 40 15 15 15 15 tWR tWR tWR tWR t + RP t + RP + t t RP 70,000 + RP 7.5 7.5 7.5 10 ns 25, 37 12 15 15 15 ns 29, 37 tRP + tRP + tRP + tRP + tCK tCK tCK tCK ns 29 2 2 2 2 tCK 37 124 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM AC Operating Specifications Table 48: AC Operating Conditions for -3E, -3, -37E, and -5E Speeds (Sheet 5 of 6) Notes: 1–5; notes appear on page 131; VDDQ = +1.8V ±0.1V, VDD = +1.8V ±0.1V AC Characteristics ODT Self Refresh Refresh Parameter Symbol -3E Min -3 Max Min -37E Max Min Max -5E Min Max CKE LOW to CK, CK# t t t t t DELAY IS + tCK +tIH IS + tCK +tIH IS + tCK +tIH IS + tCK +tIH uncertainty REFRESH-to-ACTIVE or REFRESH-totRFC 127.5 70,000 127.5 70,000 127.5 70,000 127.5 70,000 REFRESH command interval Average periodic t REFI 7.8 7.8 7.8 7.8 refresh interval (commercial) Average periodic tREFI 3.9 3.9 3.9 3.9 refresh interval IT (industrial) tRFC tRFC tRFC tRFC Exit SELF REFRESH to tXSNR (MIN) + (MIN) + (MIN) + (MIN) + non-READ command 10 10 10 10 Exit SELF REFRESH to t XSRD 200 200 200 200 READ command Exit SELF REFRESH tISXR tIS tIS tIS tIS timing reference tAOND 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 ODT turn-on delay tAC tAC tAC tAC ODT turn-on tAC tAC tAC tAC tAON (MAX) + (MAX) + (MAX) + (MAX) + (MIN) (MIN) (MIN) (MIN) 700 700 1,000 1000 tAOFD 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 ODT turn-off delay tAC tAC tAC tAC ODT turn-off tAC tAC tAC tAC tAOF (MAX) + (MAX) + (MAX) + (MAX) + (MIN) (MIN) (MIN) (MIN) 600 600 600 600 tCK tCK tCK + x 2 x 2 x 2 2 x tCK ODT turn-on (powertAC tAC tAC tAC t t t + AC + AC AC + tAC down mode) tAONPD (MIN) + (MIN) + (MIN) + (MIN) + (MAX) + (MAX) + (MAX) + (MAX) + 2,000 2,000 2000 2,000 1,000 1,000 1,000 1000 2.5 x 2.5 x 2.5 x 2.5 x ODT turn-off (powertAC tCK + tAC tCK + tAC tCK + tAC tCK + down mode) tAOFPD (MIN) + tAC tAC tAC tAC (MIN) + (MIN) + (MIN) + 2,000 (MAX) + 2,000 (MAX) + 2,000 (MAX) + 2,000 (MAX) + 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000 ODT to power-down t ANPD 3 3 3 3 entry latency ODT power-down tAXPD 8 8 8 8 exit latency ODT enable from tMOD 12 12 12 12 MRS command PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 125 Units Notes ns 26 ns 14, 37 µs 14, 37 µs 14, 37 ns tCK 37 ps 6, 27 tCK 37 ps 23, 43 tCK 35, 37 ps 24, 44 ps ps t CK 37 tCK 37 ns 37, 49 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM AC Operating Specifications Table 48: AC Operating Conditions for -3E, -3, -37E, and -5E Speeds (Sheet 6 of 6) Notes: 1–5; notes appear on page 131; VDDQ = +1.8V ±0.1V, VDD = +1.8V ±0.1V AC Characteristics Power-Down Parameter Symbol Exit active powerdown to READ t XARD command, MR[12] = 0 Exit active powerdown to READ tXARDS command, MR[12] = 1 Exit precharge tXP power-down to any non-READ command CKE MIN HIGH/LOW tCKE time PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN -3E Min -3 Max Min -37E Max Min Max -5E Min 2 2 2 2 7 - AL 7 - AL 6 - AL 2 2 3 3 126 Max Units Notes t CK 37 6 - AL tCK 37 2 2 tCK 37 3 3 tCK 32, 37 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM AC Operating Specifications Table 49: AC Operating Conditions for -25E and -25 Speeds (Sheet 1 of 4) Notes: 1–5; notes appear on page 131; VDDQ = +1.8V ±0.1V, VDD = +1.8V ±0.1V AC Characteristics Parameter Clock cycle time Symbol CL = 6 CL = 5 CL = 4 CK high-level width CK low-level width Half-clock period Clock -25E t CKAVG(6) AVG(5) t CKAVG(4) t CHAVG t CLAVG tCK t HP Absolute tCK t Min Max Min Max – 2,500 3,750 0.48 0.48 MIN (tCH, tCL) – 8,000 8,000 0.52 0.52 2,500 3,000 N/A 0.48 0.48 MIN (tCH, tCL) 8,000 8,000 N/A 0.52 0.52 CKAVG(MIN) + tCKAVG(MAX) tCKAVG(MIN) + tCKAVG(MAX) t JITPER(MIN) + JITPER(MAX) Units ps ps ps t CK t CK ps t t t Notes 16, 22, 36, 38 45 45 46 ps t JITPER(MIN) + JITPER(MAX) Absolute CK high-level width tCH ABS t t t tCK AVG(MIN) * CKAVG(MAX) * CKAVG(MIN) * CKAVG(MAX) * tCH t t t AVG(MIN) + CHAVG(MAX) + CHAVG(MIN)+ CHAVG(MAX) + tJIT tJIT tJIT tJIT DTY(MIN) DTY(MAX) DTY(MIN) DTY(MAX) ps Absolute CK low-level width tCL ABS tCK AVG(MIN) * tCL AVG(MIN) + tJIT DTY(MIN) tCK AVG(MAX) t * CLAVG(MAX) + tJITDTY(MAX) ps Clock jitter – period tJIT PER –100 100 –100 100 ps 39 –100 100 –100 100 ps 40 ps 41 tJIT Clock jitter – half period DUTY Cumulative jitter error, 2 cycles tERR 2per Cumulative jitter error, 3 cycles tERR 3per Cumulative jitter error, 4 cycles tERR 4per Cumulative jitter error, 5 cycles tERR 5per tERR Cumulative jitter error, 6–10 cycles Cumulative jitter error, 11–50 cycles PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 610per t ERR11-50per tCK t AVG(MAX) CKAVG(MIN) * * tCLAVG(MAX) tCLAVG(MIN) + + tJITDTY(MAX) tJITDTY(MIN) 200 tJIT CC Clock jitter – cycle to cycle Clock Jitter CKabs -25 200 –150 150 –150 150 ps 42 –175 175 –175 175 ps 42 –200 200 –200 200 ps 42 –200 200 –200 200 ps 42, 48 –300 300 –300 300 ps 42, 48 –450 450 –450 450 ps 42 127 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM AC Operating Specifications Table 49: AC Operating Conditions for -25E and -25 Speeds (Sheet 2 of 4) Notes: 1–5; notes appear on page 131; VDDQ = +1.8V ±0.1V, VDD = +1.8V ±0.1V AC Characteristics Data Parameter -25E Symbol t AC DQ output access time from CK/CK# Data-out High-Z window from CK/CK# DQS Low-Z window from CK/CK# t LZ1 DQ Low-Z window from CK/CK# t DQ and DM input setup time relative to DQS DQ and DM input hold time relative to DQS DQ and DM input setup time relative to DQS DQ and DM input hold time relative to DQS DQ and DM input pulse width (for each input) Data hold skew factor DQ–DQS hold from DQS Data Strobe Max Min +400 (MAX) –400 tAC t Units Notes +400 (MAX) ps ps AC (MAX) 34, 43 8, 9, 43 8, 10, 43 8, 10, 43 Max tAC AC (MIN) t LZ2 2 * tAC (MIN) t t DSa 250 250 ps 15, 19 tDH a 250 250 ps 15, 19 50 50 ps 15, 19 125 125 ps 15, 19 0.35 0.35 tCK 37 ps 47 15, 17, 47 tDS b tDH b tDIPW tQHS tQH tDVW tDQSH DQS input-high pulse width tDQSL DQS input-low pulse width tDQSCK DQS output access time from CK/CK# tDSS DQS falling edge to CK rising – setup time DQS falling edge from CK rising – hold tDSH time DQS–DQ skew, DQS to last DQ valid, per t DQSQ group, per access DQS read preamble tRPRE AC (MAX) AC (MAX) t AC (MIN) t ps 2 * tAC (MIN) t ps 300 tHP -tQHS tQH 300 tHP -tQHS tQH - tDQSQ 0.35 0.35 –350 0.2 AC (MAX) +350 0.2 ps - tDQSQ ns 15, 17 0.35 0.35 –350 0.2 tCK tCK 37 37 34, 43 37 tCK 37 200 ps 15, 17 tCK +350 0.2 200 ps 0.9 1.1 0.9 1.1 tCK tRPST 0.4 0.6 0.4 0.6 tCK WPRES tWPST 0 0.35 0.4 0.6 0 0.35 0.4 0.6 tCK 33, 34, 37, 43 33, 34, 37, 43 12, 13 37 11, 37 tDQSS –0.25 +0.25 –0.25 +0.25 tCK 37 DQS read postamble PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN –400 tHZ Data valid output window (DVW) Write preamble setup time DQS write preamble DQS write postamble Positive DQS latching edge to associated clock edge WRITE command to first DQS latching transition Min -25 t tWPRE ps tCK WL - tDQSS WL + tDQSS WL - tDQSS WL + tDQSS 128 t CK Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM AC Operating Specifications Table 49: AC Operating Conditions for -25E and -25 Speeds (Sheet 3 of 4) Notes: 1–5; notes appear on page 131; VDDQ = +1.8V ±0.1V, VDD = +1.8V ±0.1V AC Characteristics Self Refresh Refresh Command and Address Parameter Address and control input pulse width for each input Address and control input setup time Address and control input hold time Address and control input setup time Address and control input hold time CAS# to CAS# command delay ACTIVE-to-ACTIVE (same bank) command ACTIVE bank a to ACTIVE bank b command ACTIVE-to-READ or WRITE delay 4-bank activate period 4-bank activate period -25E Symbol t Min -25 Max Min Max Units Notes IPW 0.6 0.6 t CK 37 tIS 375 375 175 250 2 55 375 375 175 250 2 55 ps ps ps ps t CK ns 19 19 19 19 37 31, 37 7.5 7.5 ns 25, 37 10 10 ns 25, 37 12.5 15 ns 37 37.5 37.5 ns 28, 37 50 50 ns 28, 37 a t IHa tIS b t IHb t CCD tRC tRRD (x4, x8) tRRD (x16) tRCD tFAW (1K page) tFAW (2K page) ACTIVE-to-PRECHARGE command tRAS 45 Internal READ-to-PRECHARGE command delay Write recovery time Auto precharge write recovery + precharge time Internal WRITE-to-READ command delay PRECHARGE command period PRECHARGE ALL command period LOAD MODE command cycle time CKE low to CK, CK# uncertainty REFRESH-to-ACTIVE or REFRESH-toREFRESH command interval Average periodic refresh interval Average periodic refresh interval (industrial) Exit self refresh to non-READ command tRTP 7.5 7.5 ns tWR 15 15 ns 18, 31, 37 21, 25, 37 25, 37 ns 20 ns ns ns tCK ns 25, 37 29, 37 29 37 26 70,000 ns 14, 37 7.8 7.8 µs 14, 37 3.9 3.9 µs 14, 37 Exit self refresh to READ command Exit self refresh timing reference PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN tDAL tWR tWTR 7.5 12.5 tRP + tCK 2 t IS + tCK +tIH tRP tRPA tMRD t 70,000 DELAY tRFC + tRP 127.5 tREFI tREFI IT 45 tWR 70,000 70,000 + tRP 10 15 tRP + tCK 2 t IS + tCK +tIH 127.5 ns tXSRD t RFC (MIN) + 10 200 t RFC (MIN) + 10 200 tCK 37 tISXR tIS tIS ps 6, 27 tXSNR 129 ns Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM AC Operating Specifications Table 49: AC Operating Conditions for -25E and -25 Speeds (Sheet 4 of 4) Notes: 1–5; notes appear on page 131; VDDQ = +1.8V ±0.1V, VDD = +1.8V ±0.1V AC Characteristics Parameter ODT turn-on delay ODT turn-on ODT turn-off delay ODT ODT turn-off ODT turn-on (power-down mode) Power-Down ODT turn-off (power-down mode) ODT to power-down entry latency ODT power-down exit latency ODT enable from MRS command Exit active power-down to READ command, MR[12] = 0 Exit active power-down to READ command, MR[12] = 1 Exit precharge power-down to any nonREAD command CKE MIN HIGH/LOW time PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN -25E Symbol t AOND Min -25 Max Min 2 Max 2 2 2 tAC (MAX) (MAX) t t t AON AC (MIN) AC (MIN) + 700 + 700 tAOFD 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 t t AC (MAX) t AC (MAX) t t AOF AC (MIN) AC (MIN) + 600 + 600 t 2 x CK + 2 x tCK + tAC tAC t t AC AC t AONPD (MIN) + (MIN) + (MAX) + (MAX) + 2,000 2,000 1,000 1,000 2.5 x tCK + 2.5 x tCK + t tAC tAC (MIN) + tAC tAOFPD AC (MIN) + 2,000 (MAX) + 2,000 (MAX) + 1,000 1,000 tANPD 3 3 tAXPD 10 10 tMOD 12 12 tAC Units t Notes CK 37 ps 23, 43 tCK 35, 37 ps 24, 44 ps ps tCK ns 37 37 37, 49 tCK tXARD 2 2 tCK 37 tXARDS 8 - AL 8 - AL tCK 37 tXP 2 2 tCK 37 tCKE 3 3 tCK 32, 37 130 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Notes Notes 1. All voltages are referenced to VSS. 2. Tests for AC timing, IDD, and electrical AC and DC characteristics may be conducted at nominal reference/supply voltage levels, but the related specifications and device operation are guaranteed for the full voltage range specified. ODT is disabled for all measurements that are not ODT-specific. 3. Outputs measured with equivalent load: VTT = VDDQ/2 Output (VOUT) 25Ω Reference Point 4. AC timing and IDD tests may use a VIL-to-VIH swing of up to 1.0V in the test environment and parameter specifications are guaranteed for the specified AC input levels under normal use conditions. The slew rate for the input signals used to test the device is 1.0 V/ns for signals in the range between VIL(AC) and VIH(AC). Slew rates other than 1.0 V/ns may require the timing parameters to be derated as specified. 5. The AC and DC input level specifications are as defined in the SSTL_18 standard (i.e., the receiver will effectively switch as a result of the signal crossing the AC input level and will remain in that state as long as the signal does not ring back above [below] the DC input LOW [HIGH] level). 6. There are two sets of values listed for Command/Address: tISa, tIHa and tISb, tIHb. The t ISa, tIHa values (for reference only) are equivalent to the baseline values of tISb, tIHb at VREF when the slew rate is 1 V/ns. The baseline values, tISb, tIHb, are the JEDECdefined values, referenced from the logic trip points. tISb is referenced from VIH(AC) for a rising signal and VIL(AC) for a falling signal, while tIHb is referenced from VIL(DC) for a rising signal and VIH(DC) for a falling signal. If the Command/Address slew rate is not equal to 1 V/ns, then the baseline values must be derated by adding the values from Tables 26 and 27 on page 94. 7. The values listed are for the differential DQS strobe (DQS and DQS#) with a differential slew rate of 2 V/ns (1 V/ns for each signal). There are two sets of values listed: tDSa, t DHa and tDSb, tDHb. The tDSa, tDHa values (for reference only) are equivalent to the baseline values of tDSb, tDHb at VREF when the slew rate is 2 V/ns, differentially. The baseline values, tDSb, tDHb, are the JEDEC-defined values, referenced from the logic trip points. tDSb is referenced from VIH(AC) for a rising signal and VIL(AC) for a falling signal, while tDHb is referenced from VIL(DC) for a rising signal and VIH(DC) for a falling signal. If the differential DQS slew rate is not equal to 2 V/ns, then the baseline values must be derated by adding the values from Tables 28 and 29 on pages 99–100. If the DQS differential strobe feature is not enabled, then the DQS strobe is singleended, the baseline values not applicable, and timing is not referenced to the logic trip points. Single-ended DQS data timing is referenced to DQS crossing VREF. The correct timing values for a single-ended DQS strobe are listed in Tables 30–33 on pages 101–102; listed values are already derated for slew rate variations and can be used directly from the table. 8. tHZ and tLZ transitions occur in the same access time windows as valid data transitions. These parameters are not referenced to a specific voltage level, but specify when the device output is no longer driving (tHZ) or begins driving (tLZ). 9. This maximum value is derived from the referenced test load. tHZ (MAX) will prevail over tDQSCK (MAX) + tRPST (MAX) condition. 10. tLZ (MIN) will prevail over a tDQSCK (MIN) + tRPRE (MAX) condition. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 131 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Notes 11. The intent of the “Don’t Care” state after completion of the postamble is that the DQSdriven signal should either be HIGH, LOW, or High-Z, and that any signal transition within the input switching region must follow valid input requirements. That is, if DQS transitions HIGH (above VIH[DC] MIN), then it must not transition LOW (below VIH[DC]) prior to tDQSH (MIN). 12. This is not a device limit. The device will operate with a negative value, but system performance could be degraded due to bus turnaround. 13. It is recommended that DQS be valid (HIGH or LOW) on or before the WRITE command. The case shown (DQS going from High-Z to logic LOW) applies when no WRITEs were previously in progress on the bus. If a previous WRITE was in progress, DQS could be HIGH during this time, depending on tDQSS. 14. The refresh period is 64ms (commercial) or 32ms (industrial). This equates to an average refresh rate of 7.8125µs (commercial) or 3.9607µs (industrial). However, a REFRESH command must be asserted at least once every 70.3µs or tRFC (MAX). To ensure all rows of all banks are properly refreshed, 8,192 REFRESH commands must be issued every 64ms (commercial) or 32ms (industrial). 15. Referenced to each output group: x4 = DQS with DQ0–DQ3; x8 = DQS with DQ0–DQ7; x16 = LDQS with DQ0–DQ7; and UDQS with DQ8–DQ15. 16. CK and CK# input slew rate is referenced at 1 V/ns (2 V/ns if measured differentially). 17. The data valid window is derived by achieving other specifications: tHP (tCK/2), t DQSQ, and tQH (tQH = tHP - tQHS). The data valid window derates in direct proportion to the clock duty cycle and a practical data valid window can be derived. 18. READs and WRITEs with auto precharge are allowed to be issued before tRAS (MIN) is satisfied since tRAS lockout feature is supported in DDR2 SDRAM. 19. VIL/VIH DDR2 overshoot/undershoot. See “AC Overshoot/Undershoot Specification” on page 110. t 20. DAL = (nWR) + (tRP/tCK). Each of these terms, if not already an integer, should be rounded up to the next integer. tCK refers to the application clock period; nWR refers to the tWR parameter stored in the MR[11, 10, 9]. For example, -37E at tCK = 3.75ns with tWR programmed to four clocks would have tDAL = 4 + (15ns/3.75ns) clocks = 4 + (4) clocks = 8 clocks. 21. The minimum internal READ to PRECHARGE time. This is the time from the last 4-bit prefetch begins to when the PRECHARGE command can be issued. A 4-bit prefetch is when the READ command internally latches the READ so that data will output CL later. This parameter is only applicable when tRTP / (2 x tCK) > 1, such as frequencies faster than 533 MHz when tRTP = 7.5ns. If tRTP / (2 x tCK) ≤ 1, then equation AL + BL/ 2 applies. tRAS (MIN) also has to be satisfied as well. The DDR2 SDRAM will automatically delay the internal PRECHARGE command until tRAS (MIN) has been satisfied. 22. Operating frequency is only allowed to change during self refresh mode (see Figure 58 on page 76), precharge power-down mode, or system reset condition (See “Reset Function” on page 77). SSC allows for small deviations in operating frequency, provided the SSC guidelines are satisfied. 23. ODT turn-on time tAON (MIN) is when the device leaves High-Z and ODT resistance begins to turn on. ODT turn-on time tAON (MAX) is when the ODT resistance is fully on. Both are measured from tAOND. 24. ODT turn-off time tAOF (MIN) is when the device starts to turn off ODT resistance. ODT turn off time tAOF (MAX) is when the bus is in High-Z. Both are measured from tAOFD. 25. This parameter has a two clock minimum requirement at any tCK. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 132 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Notes 26. tDELAY is calculated from tIS + tCK + tIH so that CKE registration LOW is guaranteed prior to CK, CK# being removed in a system RESET condition. See “Reset Function” on page 77. t 27. ISXR is equal to tIS and is used for CKE setup time during self refresh exit, as shown in Figure 47 on page 67. 28. No more than four bank-ACTIVE commands may be issued in a given tFAW (MIN) period. tRRD (MIN) restriction still applies. The tFAW (MIN) parameter applies to all 8-bank DDR2 devices, regardless of the number of banks already open or closed. 29. tRPA timing applies when the PRECHARGE (ALL) command is issued, regardless of the number of banks already open or closed. If a single-bank PRECHARGE command is issued, tRP timing applies. tRPA (MIN) applies to all 8-bank DDR2 devices. 30. N/A. 31. This is applicable to READ cycles only. WRITE cycles generally require additional time due to tWR during auto precharge. t 32. CKE (MIN) of three clocks means CKE must be registered on three consecutive positive clock edges. CKE must remain at the valid input level the entire time it takes to achieve the three clocks of registration. Thus, after any CKE transition, CKE may not transition from its valid level during the time period of tIS + 2 x tCK + tIH. 33. This parameter is not referenced to a specific voltage level, but specified when the device output is no longer driving (tRPST) or beginning to drive (tRPRE). 34. When DQS is used single-ended, the minimum limit is reduced by 100ps. 35. The half-clock of tAOFD’s 2.5 tCK assumes a 50/50 clock duty cycle. This half-clock value must be derated by the amount of half-clock duty cycle error. For example, if the clock duty cycle was 47/53, tAOFD would actually be 2.5 - 0.03, or 2.47, for tAOF (MIN) and 2.5 + 0.03, or 2.53, for tAOF (MAX). 36. The clock’s tCKAVG is the average clock over any 200 consecutive clocks and tCKAVG (MIN) is the smallest clock rate allowed, except a deviation due to allowed clock jitter. Input clock jitter is allowed provided it does not exceed values specified. Also, the jitter must be of a random Gaussian distribution in nature. 37. The inputs to the DRAM must be aligned to the associated clock; that is, the actual clock that latches it in. However, the input timing (in ns) references to the tCKAVG when determining the required number of clocks. The following input parameters are determined by taking the specified percentage times the tCKAVG rather than tCK: tIPW, tDIPW, tDQSS, tDQSH, tDQSL, tDSS, tDSH, tWPST, and tWPRE. 38. Spread spectrum is not included in the jitter specification values. However, the input clock can accommodate spread spectrum at a sweep rate in the range 20–60 KHz with additional one percent of tCKAVG as a long-term jitter component; however, the spread spectrum may not use a clock rate below tCKAVG(MIN) or above tCKAVG(MAX). 39. The period jitter (tJITPER) is the maximum deviation in the clock period from the average or nominal clock allowed in either the positive or negative direction. JEDEC specifies tighter jitter numbers during DLL locking time. During DLL lock time, the jitter values should be 20 percent less than noted in the table (DLL locked). 40. The half-period jitter (tJITDTY) applies to either the high pulse of clock or the low pulse of clock; however, the two cumulatively can not exceed tJITPER. 41. The cycle-to-cycle jitter (tJITCC) is the amount the clock period can deviate from one cycle to the following cycle. JEDEC specifies tighter jitter numbers during DLL locking time. During DLL lock time, the jitter values should be 20 percent less than noted in the table (DLL locked). 42. The cumulative jitter error (tERRnPER), where n is 2, 3, 4, 5, 6–10, or 11–50, is the amount of clock time allowed to consecutively accumulate away from the average clock over any number of clock cycles. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 133 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Notes 43. The DRAM output timing is aligned to the nominal or average clock. Most output parameters must be derated by the actual jitter error when input clock jitter is present; this will result in each parameter becoming larger. The following parameters are required to be derated by subtracting tERR5PER (MAX): tAC (MIN), tDQSCK (MIN), t LZDQS (MIN), tLZDQ (MIN), tAON (MIN); while these following parameters are required to be derated by subtracting tERR5PER (MIN): tAC (MAX), tDQSCK (MAX), tHZ (MAX), tLZDQS (MAX), tLZDQ (MAX), tAON (MAX). The parameter tRPRE (MIN) is derated by subtracting tJITPER (MAX), while tRPRE (MAX), is derated by subtracting tJITPER (MIN). The parameter tRPST (MIN) is derated by subtracting tJITDTY (MAX), while t RPST (MAX), is derated by subtracting tJITDTY (MIN). 44. Half-clock output parameters must be derated by the actual tERR5PER and tJITDTY when input clock jitter is present; this will result in each parameter becoming larger. The parameter tAOF (MIN) is required to be derated by subtracting both tERR5PER (MAX) and tJITDTY (MAX). The parameter tAOF (MAX) is required to be derated by subtracting both tERR5PER (MIN) and tJITDTY (MIN). 45. MIN(tCL, tCH) refers to the smaller of the actual clock LOW time and the actual clock HIGH time driven to the device. The clock’s half period must also be of a Gaussian distribution; tCHAVG and tCLAVG must be met with or without clock jitter and with or without duty cycle jitter. tCHAVG and tCLAVG are the average of any 200 consecutive CK falling edges. 46. tHP (MIN) is the lesser of tCL and tCH actually applied to the device CK and CK# inputs; thus, tHP (MIN) ≥ the lesser of tCLABS (MIN) and tCHABS (MIN). 47. tQH = tHP - tQHS; the worst case tQH would be the smaller of tCLABS (MAX) or tCHABS (MAX) times tCKABS (MIN) - tQHS. Minimizing the amount of tCHAVG offset and value of tJITDTY will provide a larger tQH, which in turn will provide a larger valid data out window. 48. JEDEC specifies using tERR6–10PER when derating clock-related output timing (notes 43–44). Micron requires less derating by allowing tERR5PER to be used. 49. Requires 8 tCK for backward compatibility. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 134 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Package Dimensions Package Dimensions Figure 92: 84-Ball FBGA Package – 10mm x 16.5mm (x16) 0.65 ±0.05 0.155 ±0.013 SEATING PLANE C 0.10 C SOLDER BALL MATERIAL: 96.5% Sn, 3% Ag, 0.5% Cu SOLDER BALL PAD: Ø 0.33 NON SOLDER MASK DEFINED SUBSTRATE: PLASTIC LAMINATE MOLD COMPOUND: EPOXY NOVOLAC 1.80 ±0.05 CTR 6.40 84X Ø 0.45 SOLDER BALL DIAMETER REFERS TO POST REFLOW CONDITION. THE PRE-REFLOW DIAMETER IS Ø 0.42 0.80 TYP BALL A1 ID BALL A1 ID BALL A1 8.25 ±0.05 BALL A9 CL 11.20 5.60 16.50 ±0.10 0.80 TYP CL 3.20 5.00 ±0.05 1.00 MAX 10.00 ±0.10 Note: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN All dimensions are in millimeters. 135 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Package Dimensions Figure 93: 68-Ball FBGA Package – 10mm x 16.5mm (x4/x8) 0.65 ±0.05 0.155 ±0.013 SEATING PLANE C 0.10 C SOLDER BALL MATERIAL: 96.5% Sn, 3% Ag, 0.5% Cu SOLDER BALL PAD: Ø 0.33 NON SOLDER MASK DEFINED 1.80 ±0.05 CTR 68X Ø0.45 SOLDER BALL DIAMETER REFERS TO POST REFLOW CONDITION. THE PRE-REFLOW DIAMETER IS Ø0.42. SUBSTRATE: PLASTIC LAMINATE MOLD COMPOUND: EPOXY NOVOLAC 6.40 BALL A1 BALL A1 ID 0.80 TYP BALL A9 BALL #1 ID 3.20 8.25 ±0.05 CL 14.40 16.50 ±0.10 7.20 0.80 TYP CL 3.20 5.00 ±0.05 1.00 MAX 10.00 ±0.10 Note: PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN All dimensions are in millimeters. 136 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved. 1Gb: x4, x8, x16 DDR2 SDRAM Package Dimensions Figure 94: 92-Ball FBGA Package – 11mm x 19mm (x4/x8/x16) 0.80 ±0.05 0.17 MAX SEATING PLANE C 0.10 C 92X Ø 0.45 SOLDER BALL DIAMETER REFERS TO POST REFLOW CONDITION. THE PRE-REFLOW DIAMETER IS Ø 0.42. SOLDER BALL MATERIAL: 62% Sn, 36% Pb, 2% Ag OR 96.5% Sn, 3% Ag, 0.5% Cu SOLDER BALL PAD: Ø 0.33 NON SOLDER MASK DEFINED 1.80 ±0.05 CTR SUBSTRATE: PLASTIC LAMINATE 6.40 MOLD COMPOUND: EPOXY NOVOLAC BALL A1 ID BALL A1 BALL A1 ID 0.80 TYP 2.40 9.50 ±0.05 BALL A9 CL 16.00 19.00 ±0.10 8.00 0.80 TYP CL 3.20 1.20 MAX 5.50 ±0.05 11.00 ±0.10 Note: All dimensions are in millimeters. ® 8000 S. Federal Way, P.O. Box 6, Boise, ID 83707-0006, Tel: 208-368-3900 prodmktg@micron.com www.micron.com Customer Comment Line: 800-932-4992 Micron, the M logo, and the Micron logo are trademarks of Micron Technology, Inc. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. This data sheet contains minimum and maximum limits specified over the complete power supply and temperature range for production devices. Although considered final, these specifications are subject to change, as further product development and data characterization sometimes occur. PDF: 09005aef821ae8bf/Source: 09005aef821aed36 1GbDDR2_2.fm - Rev. K 4/06 EN 137 Micron Technology, Inc., reserves the right to change products or specifications without notice. ©2004 Micron Technology, Inc. All rights reserved.
MT47H256M4B7-37E:ATR 价格&库存

很抱歉,暂时无法提供与“MT47H256M4B7-37E:ATR”相匹配的价格&库存,您可以联系我们找货

免费人工找货